]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blob - gcc/var-tracking.c
[debug] Fix pre_dec handling in vartrack
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / var-tracking.c
1 /* Variable tracking routines for the GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 2002-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3
4 This file is part of GCC.
5
6 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it
7 under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
8 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option)
9 any later version.
10
11 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT
12 ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY
13 or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public
14 License for more details.
15
16 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
17 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
18 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* This file contains the variable tracking pass. It computes where
21 variables are located (which registers or where in memory) at each position
22 in instruction stream and emits notes describing the locations.
23 Debug information (DWARF2 location lists) is finally generated from
24 these notes.
25 With this debug information, it is possible to show variables
26 even when debugging optimized code.
27
28 How does the variable tracking pass work?
29
30 First, it scans RTL code for uses, stores and clobbers (register/memory
31 references in instructions), for call insns and for stack adjustments
32 separately for each basic block and saves them to an array of micro
33 operations.
34 The micro operations of one instruction are ordered so that
35 pre-modifying stack adjustment < use < use with no var < call insn <
36 < clobber < set < post-modifying stack adjustment
37
38 Then, a forward dataflow analysis is performed to find out how locations
39 of variables change through code and to propagate the variable locations
40 along control flow graph.
41 The IN set for basic block BB is computed as a union of OUT sets of BB's
42 predecessors, the OUT set for BB is copied from the IN set for BB and
43 is changed according to micro operations in BB.
44
45 The IN and OUT sets for basic blocks consist of a current stack adjustment
46 (used for adjusting offset of variables addressed using stack pointer),
47 the table of structures describing the locations of parts of a variable
48 and for each physical register a linked list for each physical register.
49 The linked list is a list of variable parts stored in the register,
50 i.e. it is a list of triplets (reg, decl, offset) where decl is
51 REG_EXPR (reg) and offset is REG_OFFSET (reg). The linked list is used for
52 effective deleting appropriate variable parts when we set or clobber the
53 register.
54
55 There may be more than one variable part in a register. The linked lists
56 should be pretty short so it is a good data structure here.
57 For example in the following code, register allocator may assign same
58 register to variables A and B, and both of them are stored in the same
59 register in CODE:
60
61 if (cond)
62 set A;
63 else
64 set B;
65 CODE;
66 if (cond)
67 use A;
68 else
69 use B;
70
71 Finally, the NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION notes describing the variable locations
72 are emitted to appropriate positions in RTL code. Each such a note describes
73 the location of one variable at the point in instruction stream where the
74 note is. There is no need to emit a note for each variable before each
75 instruction, we only emit these notes where the location of variable changes
76 (this means that we also emit notes for changes between the OUT set of the
77 previous block and the IN set of the current block).
78
79 The notes consist of two parts:
80 1. the declaration (from REG_EXPR or MEM_EXPR)
81 2. the location of a variable - it is either a simple register/memory
82 reference (for simple variables, for example int),
83 or a parallel of register/memory references (for a large variables
84 which consist of several parts, for example long long).
85
86 */
87
88 #include "config.h"
89 #include "system.h"
90 #include "coretypes.h"
91 #include "backend.h"
92 #include "target.h"
93 #include "rtl.h"
94 #include "tree.h"
95 #include "cfghooks.h"
96 #include "alloc-pool.h"
97 #include "tree-pass.h"
98 #include "memmodel.h"
99 #include "tm_p.h"
100 #include "insn-config.h"
101 #include "regs.h"
102 #include "emit-rtl.h"
103 #include "recog.h"
104 #include "diagnostic.h"
105 #include "varasm.h"
106 #include "stor-layout.h"
107 #include "cfgrtl.h"
108 #include "cfganal.h"
109 #include "reload.h"
110 #include "calls.h"
111 #include "tree-dfa.h"
112 #include "tree-ssa.h"
113 #include "cselib.h"
114 #include "params.h"
115 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
116 #include "rtl-iter.h"
117 #include "fibonacci_heap.h"
118 #include "print-rtl.h"
119
120 typedef fibonacci_heap <long, basic_block_def> bb_heap_t;
121 typedef fibonacci_node <long, basic_block_def> bb_heap_node_t;
122
123 /* var-tracking.c assumes that tree code with the same value as VALUE rtx code
124 has no chance to appear in REG_EXPR/MEM_EXPRs and isn't a decl.
125 Currently the value is the same as IDENTIFIER_NODE, which has such
126 a property. If this compile time assertion ever fails, make sure that
127 the new tree code that equals (int) VALUE has the same property. */
128 extern char check_value_val[(int) VALUE == (int) IDENTIFIER_NODE ? 1 : -1];
129
130 /* Type of micro operation. */
131 enum micro_operation_type
132 {
133 MO_USE, /* Use location (REG or MEM). */
134 MO_USE_NO_VAR,/* Use location which is not associated with a variable
135 or the variable is not trackable. */
136 MO_VAL_USE, /* Use location which is associated with a value. */
137 MO_VAL_LOC, /* Use location which appears in a debug insn. */
138 MO_VAL_SET, /* Set location associated with a value. */
139 MO_SET, /* Set location. */
140 MO_COPY, /* Copy the same portion of a variable from one
141 location to another. */
142 MO_CLOBBER, /* Clobber location. */
143 MO_CALL, /* Call insn. */
144 MO_ADJUST /* Adjust stack pointer. */
145
146 };
147
148 static const char * const ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
149 micro_operation_type_name[] = {
150 "MO_USE",
151 "MO_USE_NO_VAR",
152 "MO_VAL_USE",
153 "MO_VAL_LOC",
154 "MO_VAL_SET",
155 "MO_SET",
156 "MO_COPY",
157 "MO_CLOBBER",
158 "MO_CALL",
159 "MO_ADJUST"
160 };
161
162 /* Where shall the note be emitted? BEFORE or AFTER the instruction.
163 Notes emitted as AFTER_CALL are to take effect during the call,
164 rather than after the call. */
165 enum emit_note_where
166 {
167 EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN,
168 EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN,
169 EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN
170 };
171
172 /* Structure holding information about micro operation. */
173 struct micro_operation
174 {
175 /* Type of micro operation. */
176 enum micro_operation_type type;
177
178 /* The instruction which the micro operation is in, for MO_USE,
179 MO_USE_NO_VAR, MO_CALL and MO_ADJUST, or the subsequent
180 instruction or note in the original flow (before any var-tracking
181 notes are inserted, to simplify emission of notes), for MO_SET
182 and MO_CLOBBER. */
183 rtx_insn *insn;
184
185 union {
186 /* Location. For MO_SET and MO_COPY, this is the SET that
187 performs the assignment, if known, otherwise it is the target
188 of the assignment. For MO_VAL_USE and MO_VAL_SET, it is a
189 CONCAT of the VALUE and the LOC associated with it. For
190 MO_VAL_LOC, it is a CONCAT of the VALUE and the VAR_LOCATION
191 associated with it. */
192 rtx loc;
193
194 /* Stack adjustment. */
195 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust;
196 } u;
197 };
198
199
200 /* A declaration of a variable, or an RTL value being handled like a
201 declaration. */
202 typedef void *decl_or_value;
203
204 /* Return true if a decl_or_value DV is a DECL or NULL. */
205 static inline bool
206 dv_is_decl_p (decl_or_value dv)
207 {
208 return !dv || (int) TREE_CODE ((tree) dv) != (int) VALUE;
209 }
210
211 /* Return true if a decl_or_value is a VALUE rtl. */
212 static inline bool
213 dv_is_value_p (decl_or_value dv)
214 {
215 return dv && !dv_is_decl_p (dv);
216 }
217
218 /* Return the decl in the decl_or_value. */
219 static inline tree
220 dv_as_decl (decl_or_value dv)
221 {
222 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_decl_p (dv));
223 return (tree) dv;
224 }
225
226 /* Return the value in the decl_or_value. */
227 static inline rtx
228 dv_as_value (decl_or_value dv)
229 {
230 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_value_p (dv));
231 return (rtx)dv;
232 }
233
234 /* Return the opaque pointer in the decl_or_value. */
235 static inline void *
236 dv_as_opaque (decl_or_value dv)
237 {
238 return dv;
239 }
240
241
242 /* Description of location of a part of a variable. The content of a physical
243 register is described by a chain of these structures.
244 The chains are pretty short (usually 1 or 2 elements) and thus
245 chain is the best data structure. */
246 struct attrs
247 {
248 /* Pointer to next member of the list. */
249 attrs *next;
250
251 /* The rtx of register. */
252 rtx loc;
253
254 /* The declaration corresponding to LOC. */
255 decl_or_value dv;
256
257 /* Offset from start of DECL. */
258 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
259 };
260
261 /* Structure for chaining the locations. */
262 struct location_chain
263 {
264 /* Next element in the chain. */
265 location_chain *next;
266
267 /* The location (REG, MEM or VALUE). */
268 rtx loc;
269
270 /* The "value" stored in this location. */
271 rtx set_src;
272
273 /* Initialized? */
274 enum var_init_status init;
275 };
276
277 /* A vector of loc_exp_dep holds the active dependencies of a one-part
278 DV on VALUEs, i.e., the VALUEs expanded so as to form the current
279 location of DV. Each entry is also part of VALUE' s linked-list of
280 backlinks back to DV. */
281 struct loc_exp_dep
282 {
283 /* The dependent DV. */
284 decl_or_value dv;
285 /* The dependency VALUE or DECL_DEBUG. */
286 rtx value;
287 /* The next entry in VALUE's backlinks list. */
288 struct loc_exp_dep *next;
289 /* A pointer to the pointer to this entry (head or prev's next) in
290 the doubly-linked list. */
291 struct loc_exp_dep **pprev;
292 };
293
294
295 /* This data structure holds information about the depth of a variable
296 expansion. */
297 struct expand_depth
298 {
299 /* This measures the complexity of the expanded expression. It
300 grows by one for each level of expansion that adds more than one
301 operand. */
302 int complexity;
303 /* This counts the number of ENTRY_VALUE expressions in an
304 expansion. We want to minimize their use. */
305 int entryvals;
306 };
307
308 /* This data structure is allocated for one-part variables at the time
309 of emitting notes. */
310 struct onepart_aux
311 {
312 /* Doubly-linked list of dependent DVs. These are DVs whose cur_loc
313 computation used the expansion of this variable, and that ought
314 to be notified should this variable change. If the DV's cur_loc
315 expanded to NULL, all components of the loc list are regarded as
316 active, so that any changes in them give us a chance to get a
317 location. Otherwise, only components of the loc that expanded to
318 non-NULL are regarded as active dependencies. */
319 loc_exp_dep *backlinks;
320 /* This holds the LOC that was expanded into cur_loc. We need only
321 mark a one-part variable as changed if the FROM loc is removed,
322 or if it has no known location and a loc is added, or if it gets
323 a change notification from any of its active dependencies. */
324 rtx from;
325 /* The depth of the cur_loc expression. */
326 expand_depth depth;
327 /* Dependencies actively used when expand FROM into cur_loc. */
328 vec<loc_exp_dep, va_heap, vl_embed> deps;
329 };
330
331 /* Structure describing one part of variable. */
332 struct variable_part
333 {
334 /* Chain of locations of the part. */
335 location_chain *loc_chain;
336
337 /* Location which was last emitted to location list. */
338 rtx cur_loc;
339
340 union variable_aux
341 {
342 /* The offset in the variable, if !var->onepart. */
343 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
344
345 /* Pointer to auxiliary data, if var->onepart and emit_notes. */
346 struct onepart_aux *onepaux;
347 } aux;
348 };
349
350 /* Maximum number of location parts. */
351 #define MAX_VAR_PARTS 16
352
353 /* Enumeration type used to discriminate various types of one-part
354 variables. */
355 enum onepart_enum
356 {
357 /* Not a one-part variable. */
358 NOT_ONEPART = 0,
359 /* A one-part DECL that is not a DEBUG_EXPR_DECL. */
360 ONEPART_VDECL = 1,
361 /* A DEBUG_EXPR_DECL. */
362 ONEPART_DEXPR = 2,
363 /* A VALUE. */
364 ONEPART_VALUE = 3
365 };
366
367 /* Structure describing where the variable is located. */
368 struct variable
369 {
370 /* The declaration of the variable, or an RTL value being handled
371 like a declaration. */
372 decl_or_value dv;
373
374 /* Reference count. */
375 int refcount;
376
377 /* Number of variable parts. */
378 char n_var_parts;
379
380 /* What type of DV this is, according to enum onepart_enum. */
381 ENUM_BITFIELD (onepart_enum) onepart : CHAR_BIT;
382
383 /* True if this variable_def struct is currently in the
384 changed_variables hash table. */
385 bool in_changed_variables;
386
387 /* The variable parts. */
388 variable_part var_part[1];
389 };
390
391 /* Pointer to the BB's information specific to variable tracking pass. */
392 #define VTI(BB) ((variable_tracking_info *) (BB)->aux)
393
394 /* Return MEM_OFFSET (MEM) as a HOST_WIDE_INT, or 0 if we can't. */
395
396 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
397 int_mem_offset (const_rtx mem)
398 {
399 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
400 if (MEM_OFFSET_KNOWN_P (mem) && MEM_OFFSET (mem).is_constant (&offset))
401 return offset;
402 return 0;
403 }
404
405 #if CHECKING_P && (GCC_VERSION >= 2007)
406
407 /* Access VAR's Ith part's offset, checking that it's not a one-part
408 variable. */
409 #define VAR_PART_OFFSET(var, i) __extension__ \
410 (*({ variable *const __v = (var); \
411 gcc_checking_assert (!__v->onepart); \
412 &__v->var_part[(i)].aux.offset; }))
413
414 /* Access VAR's one-part auxiliary data, checking that it is a
415 one-part variable. */
416 #define VAR_LOC_1PAUX(var) __extension__ \
417 (*({ variable *const __v = (var); \
418 gcc_checking_assert (__v->onepart); \
419 &__v->var_part[0].aux.onepaux; }))
420
421 #else
422 #define VAR_PART_OFFSET(var, i) ((var)->var_part[(i)].aux.offset)
423 #define VAR_LOC_1PAUX(var) ((var)->var_part[0].aux.onepaux)
424 #endif
425
426 /* These are accessor macros for the one-part auxiliary data. When
427 convenient for users, they're guarded by tests that the data was
428 allocated. */
429 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_LST(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
430 ? VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->backlinks \
431 : NULL)
432 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
433 ? &VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->backlinks \
434 : NULL)
435 #define VAR_LOC_FROM(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->from)
436 #define VAR_LOC_DEPTH(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->depth)
437 #define VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC(var) (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) \
438 ? &VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->deps \
439 : NULL)
440
441
442
443 typedef unsigned int dvuid;
444
445 /* Return the uid of DV. */
446
447 static inline dvuid
448 dv_uid (decl_or_value dv)
449 {
450 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
451 return CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (dv))->uid;
452 else
453 return DECL_UID (dv_as_decl (dv));
454 }
455
456 /* Compute the hash from the uid. */
457
458 static inline hashval_t
459 dv_uid2hash (dvuid uid)
460 {
461 return uid;
462 }
463
464 /* The hash function for a mask table in a shared_htab chain. */
465
466 static inline hashval_t
467 dv_htab_hash (decl_or_value dv)
468 {
469 return dv_uid2hash (dv_uid (dv));
470 }
471
472 static void variable_htab_free (void *);
473
474 /* Variable hashtable helpers. */
475
476 struct variable_hasher : pointer_hash <variable>
477 {
478 typedef void *compare_type;
479 static inline hashval_t hash (const variable *);
480 static inline bool equal (const variable *, const void *);
481 static inline void remove (variable *);
482 };
483
484 /* The hash function for variable_htab, computes the hash value
485 from the declaration of variable X. */
486
487 inline hashval_t
488 variable_hasher::hash (const variable *v)
489 {
490 return dv_htab_hash (v->dv);
491 }
492
493 /* Compare the declaration of variable X with declaration Y. */
494
495 inline bool
496 variable_hasher::equal (const variable *v, const void *y)
497 {
498 decl_or_value dv = CONST_CAST2 (decl_or_value, const void *, y);
499
500 return (dv_as_opaque (v->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv));
501 }
502
503 /* Free the element of VARIABLE_HTAB (its type is struct variable_def). */
504
505 inline void
506 variable_hasher::remove (variable *var)
507 {
508 variable_htab_free (var);
509 }
510
511 typedef hash_table<variable_hasher> variable_table_type;
512 typedef variable_table_type::iterator variable_iterator_type;
513
514 /* Structure for passing some other parameters to function
515 emit_note_insn_var_location. */
516 struct emit_note_data
517 {
518 /* The instruction which the note will be emitted before/after. */
519 rtx_insn *insn;
520
521 /* Where the note will be emitted (before/after insn)? */
522 enum emit_note_where where;
523
524 /* The variables and values active at this point. */
525 variable_table_type *vars;
526 };
527
528 /* Structure holding a refcounted hash table. If refcount > 1,
529 it must be first unshared before modified. */
530 struct shared_hash
531 {
532 /* Reference count. */
533 int refcount;
534
535 /* Actual hash table. */
536 variable_table_type *htab;
537 };
538
539 /* Structure holding the IN or OUT set for a basic block. */
540 struct dataflow_set
541 {
542 /* Adjustment of stack offset. */
543 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust;
544
545 /* Attributes for registers (lists of attrs). */
546 attrs *regs[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
547
548 /* Variable locations. */
549 shared_hash *vars;
550
551 /* Vars that is being traversed. */
552 shared_hash *traversed_vars;
553 };
554
555 /* The structure (one for each basic block) containing the information
556 needed for variable tracking. */
557 struct variable_tracking_info
558 {
559 /* The vector of micro operations. */
560 vec<micro_operation> mos;
561
562 /* The IN and OUT set for dataflow analysis. */
563 dataflow_set in;
564 dataflow_set out;
565
566 /* The permanent-in dataflow set for this block. This is used to
567 hold values for which we had to compute entry values. ??? This
568 should probably be dynamically allocated, to avoid using more
569 memory in non-debug builds. */
570 dataflow_set *permp;
571
572 /* Has the block been visited in DFS? */
573 bool visited;
574
575 /* Has the block been flooded in VTA? */
576 bool flooded;
577
578 };
579
580 /* Alloc pool for struct attrs_def. */
581 object_allocator<attrs> attrs_pool ("attrs pool");
582
583 /* Alloc pool for struct variable_def with MAX_VAR_PARTS entries. */
584
585 static pool_allocator var_pool
586 ("variable_def pool", sizeof (variable) +
587 (MAX_VAR_PARTS - 1) * sizeof (((variable *)NULL)->var_part[0]));
588
589 /* Alloc pool for struct variable_def with a single var_part entry. */
590 static pool_allocator valvar_pool
591 ("small variable_def pool", sizeof (variable));
592
593 /* Alloc pool for struct location_chain. */
594 static object_allocator<location_chain> location_chain_pool
595 ("location_chain pool");
596
597 /* Alloc pool for struct shared_hash. */
598 static object_allocator<shared_hash> shared_hash_pool ("shared_hash pool");
599
600 /* Alloc pool for struct loc_exp_dep_s for NOT_ONEPART variables. */
601 object_allocator<loc_exp_dep> loc_exp_dep_pool ("loc_exp_dep pool");
602
603 /* Changed variables, notes will be emitted for them. */
604 static variable_table_type *changed_variables;
605
606 /* Shall notes be emitted? */
607 static bool emit_notes;
608
609 /* Values whose dynamic location lists have gone empty, but whose
610 cselib location lists are still usable. Use this to hold the
611 current location, the backlinks, etc, during emit_notes. */
612 static variable_table_type *dropped_values;
613
614 /* Empty shared hashtable. */
615 static shared_hash *empty_shared_hash;
616
617 /* Scratch register bitmap used by cselib_expand_value_rtx. */
618 static bitmap scratch_regs = NULL;
619
620 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
621 struct GTY(()) parm_reg {
622 rtx outgoing;
623 rtx incoming;
624 };
625
626
627 /* Vector of windowed parameter registers, if any. */
628 static vec<parm_reg, va_gc> *windowed_parm_regs = NULL;
629 #endif
630
631 /* Variable used to tell whether cselib_process_insn called our hook. */
632 static bool cselib_hook_called;
633
634 /* Local function prototypes. */
635 static void stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT *,
636 HOST_WIDE_INT *);
637 static void insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx_insn *, HOST_WIDE_INT *,
638 HOST_WIDE_INT *);
639 static bool vt_stack_adjustments (void);
640
641 static void init_attrs_list_set (attrs **);
642 static void attrs_list_clear (attrs **);
643 static attrs *attrs_list_member (attrs *, decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT);
644 static void attrs_list_insert (attrs **, decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT, rtx);
645 static void attrs_list_copy (attrs **, attrs *);
646 static void attrs_list_union (attrs **, attrs *);
647
648 static variable **unshare_variable (dataflow_set *set, variable **slot,
649 variable *var, enum var_init_status);
650 static void vars_copy (variable_table_type *, variable_table_type *);
651 static tree var_debug_decl (tree);
652 static void var_reg_set (dataflow_set *, rtx, enum var_init_status, rtx);
653 static void var_reg_delete_and_set (dataflow_set *, rtx, bool,
654 enum var_init_status, rtx);
655 static void var_reg_delete (dataflow_set *, rtx, bool);
656 static void var_regno_delete (dataflow_set *, int);
657 static void var_mem_set (dataflow_set *, rtx, enum var_init_status, rtx);
658 static void var_mem_delete_and_set (dataflow_set *, rtx, bool,
659 enum var_init_status, rtx);
660 static void var_mem_delete (dataflow_set *, rtx, bool);
661
662 static void dataflow_set_init (dataflow_set *);
663 static void dataflow_set_clear (dataflow_set *);
664 static void dataflow_set_copy (dataflow_set *, dataflow_set *);
665 static int variable_union_info_cmp_pos (const void *, const void *);
666 static void dataflow_set_union (dataflow_set *, dataflow_set *);
667 static location_chain *find_loc_in_1pdv (rtx, variable *,
668 variable_table_type *);
669 static bool canon_value_cmp (rtx, rtx);
670 static int loc_cmp (rtx, rtx);
671 static bool variable_part_different_p (variable_part *, variable_part *);
672 static bool onepart_variable_different_p (variable *, variable *);
673 static bool variable_different_p (variable *, variable *);
674 static bool dataflow_set_different (dataflow_set *, dataflow_set *);
675 static void dataflow_set_destroy (dataflow_set *);
676
677 static bool track_expr_p (tree, bool);
678 static void add_uses_1 (rtx *, void *);
679 static void add_stores (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
680 static bool compute_bb_dataflow (basic_block);
681 static bool vt_find_locations (void);
682
683 static void dump_attrs_list (attrs *);
684 static void dump_var (variable *);
685 static void dump_vars (variable_table_type *);
686 static void dump_dataflow_set (dataflow_set *);
687 static void dump_dataflow_sets (void);
688
689 static void set_dv_changed (decl_or_value, bool);
690 static void variable_was_changed (variable *, dataflow_set *);
691 static variable **set_slot_part (dataflow_set *, rtx, variable **,
692 decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT,
693 enum var_init_status, rtx);
694 static void set_variable_part (dataflow_set *, rtx,
695 decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT,
696 enum var_init_status, rtx, enum insert_option);
697 static variable **clobber_slot_part (dataflow_set *, rtx,
698 variable **, HOST_WIDE_INT, rtx);
699 static void clobber_variable_part (dataflow_set *, rtx,
700 decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT, rtx);
701 static variable **delete_slot_part (dataflow_set *, rtx, variable **,
702 HOST_WIDE_INT);
703 static void delete_variable_part (dataflow_set *, rtx,
704 decl_or_value, HOST_WIDE_INT);
705 static void emit_notes_in_bb (basic_block, dataflow_set *);
706 static void vt_emit_notes (void);
707
708 static void vt_add_function_parameters (void);
709 static bool vt_initialize (void);
710 static void vt_finalize (void);
711
712 /* Callback for stack_adjust_offset_pre_post, called via for_each_inc_dec. */
713
714 static int
715 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post_cb (rtx, rtx op, rtx dest, rtx src, rtx srcoff,
716 void *arg)
717 {
718 if (dest != stack_pointer_rtx)
719 return 0;
720
721 switch (GET_CODE (op))
722 {
723 case PRE_INC:
724 case PRE_DEC:
725 ((HOST_WIDE_INT *)arg)[0] -= INTVAL (srcoff);
726 return 0;
727 case POST_INC:
728 case POST_DEC:
729 ((HOST_WIDE_INT *)arg)[1] -= INTVAL (srcoff);
730 return 0;
731 case PRE_MODIFY:
732 case POST_MODIFY:
733 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
734 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PLUS
735 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1))
736 && XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
737 ((HOST_WIDE_INT *)arg)[GET_CODE (op) == POST_MODIFY]
738 -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
739 return 0;
740 default:
741 gcc_unreachable ();
742 }
743 }
744
745 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it contains
746 PRE- and POST-modifying stack pointer.
747 This function is similar to stack_adjust_offset. */
748
749 static void
750 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx pattern, HOST_WIDE_INT *pre,
751 HOST_WIDE_INT *post)
752 {
753 rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
754 rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
755 enum rtx_code code;
756
757 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
758 {
759 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
760 code = GET_CODE (src);
761 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
762 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
763 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
764 return;
765
766 if (code == MINUS)
767 *post += INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
768 else
769 *post -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
770 return;
771 }
772 HOST_WIDE_INT res[2] = { 0, 0 };
773 for_each_inc_dec (pattern, stack_adjust_offset_pre_post_cb, res);
774 *pre += res[0];
775 *post += res[1];
776 }
777
778 /* Given an INSN, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it contains
779 PRE- and POST-modifying stack pointer. */
780
781 static void
782 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (rtx_insn *insn, HOST_WIDE_INT *pre,
783 HOST_WIDE_INT *post)
784 {
785 rtx pattern;
786
787 *pre = 0;
788 *post = 0;
789
790 pattern = PATTERN (insn);
791 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
792 {
793 rtx expr = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
794 if (expr)
795 pattern = XEXP (expr, 0);
796 }
797
798 if (GET_CODE (pattern) == SET)
799 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (pattern, pre, post);
800 else if (GET_CODE (pattern) == PARALLEL
801 || GET_CODE (pattern) == SEQUENCE)
802 {
803 int i;
804
805 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
806 for them. */
807 for ( i = XVECLEN (pattern, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
808 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i)) == SET)
809 stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (XVECEXP (pattern, 0, i), pre, post);
810 }
811 }
812
813 /* Compute stack adjustments for all blocks by traversing DFS tree.
814 Return true when the adjustments on all incoming edges are consistent.
815 Heavily borrowed from pre_and_rev_post_order_compute. */
816
817 static bool
818 vt_stack_adjustments (void)
819 {
820 edge_iterator *stack;
821 int sp;
822
823 /* Initialize entry block. */
824 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun))->visited = true;
825 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun))->in.stack_adjust
826 = INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET;
827 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun))->out.stack_adjust
828 = INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET;
829
830 /* Allocate stack for back-tracking up CFG. */
831 stack = XNEWVEC (edge_iterator, n_basic_blocks_for_fn (cfun) + 1);
832 sp = 0;
833
834 /* Push the first edge on to the stack. */
835 stack[sp++] = ei_start (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun)->succs);
836
837 while (sp)
838 {
839 edge_iterator ei;
840 basic_block src;
841 basic_block dest;
842
843 /* Look at the edge on the top of the stack. */
844 ei = stack[sp - 1];
845 src = ei_edge (ei)->src;
846 dest = ei_edge (ei)->dest;
847
848 /* Check if the edge destination has been visited yet. */
849 if (!VTI (dest)->visited)
850 {
851 rtx_insn *insn;
852 HOST_WIDE_INT pre, post, offset;
853 VTI (dest)->visited = true;
854 VTI (dest)->in.stack_adjust = offset = VTI (src)->out.stack_adjust;
855
856 if (dest != EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun))
857 for (insn = BB_HEAD (dest);
858 insn != NEXT_INSN (BB_END (dest));
859 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
860 if (INSN_P (insn))
861 {
862 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (insn, &pre, &post);
863 offset += pre + post;
864 }
865
866 VTI (dest)->out.stack_adjust = offset;
867
868 if (EDGE_COUNT (dest->succs) > 0)
869 /* Since the DEST node has been visited for the first
870 time, check its successors. */
871 stack[sp++] = ei_start (dest->succs);
872 }
873 else
874 {
875 /* We can end up with different stack adjustments for the exit block
876 of a shrink-wrapped function if stack_adjust_offset_pre_post
877 doesn't understand the rtx pattern used to restore the stack
878 pointer in the epilogue. For example, on s390(x), the stack
879 pointer is often restored via a load-multiple instruction
880 and so no stack_adjust offset is recorded for it. This means
881 that the stack offset at the end of the epilogue block is the
882 same as the offset before the epilogue, whereas other paths
883 to the exit block will have the correct stack_adjust.
884
885 It is safe to ignore these differences because (a) we never
886 use the stack_adjust for the exit block in this pass and
887 (b) dwarf2cfi checks whether the CFA notes in a shrink-wrapped
888 function are correct.
889
890 We must check whether the adjustments on other edges are
891 the same though. */
892 if (dest != EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun)
893 && VTI (dest)->in.stack_adjust != VTI (src)->out.stack_adjust)
894 {
895 free (stack);
896 return false;
897 }
898
899 if (! ei_one_before_end_p (ei))
900 /* Go to the next edge. */
901 ei_next (&stack[sp - 1]);
902 else
903 /* Return to previous level if there are no more edges. */
904 sp--;
905 }
906 }
907
908 free (stack);
909 return true;
910 }
911
912 /* arg_pointer_rtx resp. frame_pointer_rtx if stack_pointer_rtx or
913 hard_frame_pointer_rtx is being mapped to it and offset for it. */
914 static rtx cfa_base_rtx;
915 static HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_base_offset;
916
917 /* Compute a CFA-based value for an ADJUSTMENT made to stack_pointer_rtx
918 or hard_frame_pointer_rtx. */
919
920 static inline rtx
921 compute_cfa_pointer (poly_int64 adjustment)
922 {
923 return plus_constant (Pmode, cfa_base_rtx, adjustment + cfa_base_offset);
924 }
925
926 /* Adjustment for hard_frame_pointer_rtx to cfa base reg,
927 or -1 if the replacement shouldn't be done. */
928 static poly_int64 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment = -1;
929
930 /* Data for adjust_mems callback. */
931
932 struct adjust_mem_data
933 {
934 bool store;
935 machine_mode mem_mode;
936 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust;
937 auto_vec<rtx> side_effects;
938 };
939
940 /* Helper for adjust_mems. Return true if X is suitable for
941 transformation of wider mode arithmetics to narrower mode. */
942
943 static bool
944 use_narrower_mode_test (rtx x, const_rtx subreg)
945 {
946 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
947 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, x, NONCONST)
948 {
949 rtx x = *iter;
950 if (CONSTANT_P (x))
951 iter.skip_subrtxes ();
952 else
953 switch (GET_CODE (x))
954 {
955 case REG:
956 if (cselib_lookup (x, GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (subreg)), 0, VOIDmode))
957 return false;
958 if (!validate_subreg (GET_MODE (subreg), GET_MODE (x), x,
959 subreg_lowpart_offset (GET_MODE (subreg),
960 GET_MODE (x))))
961 return false;
962 break;
963 case PLUS:
964 case MINUS:
965 case MULT:
966 break;
967 case ASHIFT:
968 if (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 1)) != VOIDmode)
969 {
970 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (subreg);
971 rtx op1 = XEXP (x, 1);
972 enum machine_mode op1_mode = GET_MODE (op1);
973 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (mode))
974 < GET_MODE_PRECISION (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (op1_mode)))
975 {
976 poly_uint64 byte = subreg_lowpart_offset (mode, op1_mode);
977 if (GET_CODE (op1) == SUBREG || GET_CODE (op1) == CONCAT)
978 {
979 if (!simplify_subreg (mode, op1, op1_mode, byte))
980 return false;
981 }
982 else if (!validate_subreg (mode, op1_mode, op1, byte))
983 return false;
984 }
985 }
986 iter.substitute (XEXP (x, 0));
987 break;
988 default:
989 return false;
990 }
991 }
992 return true;
993 }
994
995 /* Transform X into narrower mode MODE from wider mode WMODE. */
996
997 static rtx
998 use_narrower_mode (rtx x, scalar_int_mode mode, scalar_int_mode wmode)
999 {
1000 rtx op0, op1;
1001 if (CONSTANT_P (x))
1002 return lowpart_subreg (mode, x, wmode);
1003 switch (GET_CODE (x))
1004 {
1005 case REG:
1006 return lowpart_subreg (mode, x, wmode);
1007 case PLUS:
1008 case MINUS:
1009 case MULT:
1010 op0 = use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x, 0), mode, wmode);
1011 op1 = use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x, 1), mode, wmode);
1012 return simplify_gen_binary (GET_CODE (x), mode, op0, op1);
1013 case ASHIFT:
1014 op0 = use_narrower_mode (XEXP (x, 0), mode, wmode);
1015 op1 = XEXP (x, 1);
1016 /* Ensure shift amount is not wider than mode. */
1017 if (GET_MODE (op1) == VOIDmode)
1018 op1 = lowpart_subreg (mode, op1, wmode);
1019 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)
1020 < GET_MODE_PRECISION (as_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (op1))))
1021 op1 = lowpart_subreg (mode, op1, GET_MODE (op1));
1022 return simplify_gen_binary (ASHIFT, mode, op0, op1);
1023 default:
1024 gcc_unreachable ();
1025 }
1026 }
1027
1028 /* Helper function for adjusting used MEMs. */
1029
1030 static rtx
1031 adjust_mems (rtx loc, const_rtx old_rtx, void *data)
1032 {
1033 struct adjust_mem_data *amd = (struct adjust_mem_data *) data;
1034 rtx mem, addr = loc, tem;
1035 machine_mode mem_mode_save;
1036 bool store_save;
1037 scalar_int_mode tem_mode, tem_subreg_mode;
1038 poly_int64 size;
1039 switch (GET_CODE (loc))
1040 {
1041 case REG:
1042 /* Don't do any sp or fp replacements outside of MEM addresses
1043 on the LHS. */
1044 if (amd->mem_mode == VOIDmode && amd->store)
1045 return loc;
1046 if (loc == stack_pointer_rtx
1047 && !frame_pointer_needed
1048 && cfa_base_rtx)
1049 return compute_cfa_pointer (amd->stack_adjust);
1050 else if (loc == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
1051 && frame_pointer_needed
1052 && maybe_ne (hard_frame_pointer_adjustment, -1)
1053 && cfa_base_rtx)
1054 return compute_cfa_pointer (hard_frame_pointer_adjustment);
1055 gcc_checking_assert (loc != virtual_incoming_args_rtx);
1056 return loc;
1057 case MEM:
1058 mem = loc;
1059 if (!amd->store)
1060 {
1061 mem = targetm.delegitimize_address (mem);
1062 if (mem != loc && !MEM_P (mem))
1063 return simplify_replace_fn_rtx (mem, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
1064 }
1065
1066 addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
1067 mem_mode_save = amd->mem_mode;
1068 amd->mem_mode = GET_MODE (mem);
1069 store_save = amd->store;
1070 amd->store = false;
1071 addr = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
1072 amd->store = store_save;
1073 amd->mem_mode = mem_mode_save;
1074 if (mem == loc)
1075 addr = targetm.delegitimize_address (addr);
1076 if (addr != XEXP (mem, 0))
1077 mem = replace_equiv_address_nv (mem, addr);
1078 if (!amd->store)
1079 mem = avoid_constant_pool_reference (mem);
1080 return mem;
1081 case PRE_INC:
1082 case PRE_DEC:
1083 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (amd->mem_mode);
1084 addr = plus_constant (GET_MODE (loc), XEXP (loc, 0),
1085 GET_CODE (loc) == PRE_INC ? size : -size);
1086 /* FALLTHRU */
1087 case POST_INC:
1088 case POST_DEC:
1089 if (addr == loc)
1090 addr = XEXP (loc, 0);
1091 gcc_assert (amd->mem_mode != VOIDmode && amd->mem_mode != BLKmode);
1092 addr = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
1093 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (amd->mem_mode);
1094 tem = plus_constant (GET_MODE (loc), XEXP (loc, 0),
1095 (GET_CODE (loc) == PRE_INC
1096 || GET_CODE (loc) == POST_INC) ? size : -size);
1097 store_save = amd->store;
1098 amd->store = false;
1099 tem = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (tem, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
1100 amd->store = store_save;
1101 amd->side_effects.safe_push (gen_rtx_SET (XEXP (loc, 0), tem));
1102 return addr;
1103 case PRE_MODIFY:
1104 addr = XEXP (loc, 1);
1105 /* FALLTHRU */
1106 case POST_MODIFY:
1107 if (addr == loc)
1108 addr = XEXP (loc, 0);
1109 gcc_assert (amd->mem_mode != VOIDmode);
1110 addr = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
1111 store_save = amd->store;
1112 amd->store = false;
1113 tem = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (XEXP (loc, 1), old_rtx,
1114 adjust_mems, data);
1115 amd->store = store_save;
1116 amd->side_effects.safe_push (gen_rtx_SET (XEXP (loc, 0), tem));
1117 return addr;
1118 case SUBREG:
1119 /* First try without delegitimization of whole MEMs and
1120 avoid_constant_pool_reference, which is more likely to succeed. */
1121 store_save = amd->store;
1122 amd->store = true;
1123 addr = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (SUBREG_REG (loc), old_rtx, adjust_mems,
1124 data);
1125 amd->store = store_save;
1126 mem = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (addr, old_rtx, adjust_mems, data);
1127 if (mem == SUBREG_REG (loc))
1128 {
1129 tem = loc;
1130 goto finish_subreg;
1131 }
1132 tem = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (loc), mem,
1133 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (loc)),
1134 SUBREG_BYTE (loc));
1135 if (tem)
1136 goto finish_subreg;
1137 tem = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (loc), addr,
1138 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (loc)),
1139 SUBREG_BYTE (loc));
1140 if (tem == NULL_RTX)
1141 tem = gen_rtx_raw_SUBREG (GET_MODE (loc), addr, SUBREG_BYTE (loc));
1142 finish_subreg:
1143 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
1144 && GET_CODE (tem) == SUBREG
1145 && (GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)) == PLUS
1146 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)) == MINUS
1147 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)) == MULT
1148 || GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)) == ASHIFT)
1149 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (tem), &tem_mode)
1150 && is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (tem)),
1151 &tem_subreg_mode)
1152 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (tem_mode)
1153 < GET_MODE_PRECISION (tem_subreg_mode))
1154 && subreg_lowpart_p (tem)
1155 && use_narrower_mode_test (SUBREG_REG (tem), tem))
1156 return use_narrower_mode (SUBREG_REG (tem), tem_mode, tem_subreg_mode);
1157 return tem;
1158 case ASM_OPERANDS:
1159 /* Don't do any replacements in second and following
1160 ASM_OPERANDS of inline-asm with multiple sets.
1161 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC, ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC
1162 and ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC need to be equal between
1163 all the ASM_OPERANDs in the insn and adjust_insn will
1164 fix this up. */
1165 if (ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (loc) != 0)
1166 return loc;
1167 break;
1168 default:
1169 break;
1170 }
1171 return NULL_RTX;
1172 }
1173
1174 /* Helper function for replacement of uses. */
1175
1176 static void
1177 adjust_mem_uses (rtx *x, void *data)
1178 {
1179 rtx new_x = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (*x, NULL_RTX, adjust_mems, data);
1180 if (new_x != *x)
1181 validate_change (NULL_RTX, x, new_x, true);
1182 }
1183
1184 /* Helper function for replacement of stores. */
1185
1186 static void
1187 adjust_mem_stores (rtx loc, const_rtx expr, void *data)
1188 {
1189 if (MEM_P (loc))
1190 {
1191 rtx new_dest = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (SET_DEST (expr), NULL_RTX,
1192 adjust_mems, data);
1193 if (new_dest != SET_DEST (expr))
1194 {
1195 rtx xexpr = CONST_CAST_RTX (expr);
1196 validate_change (NULL_RTX, &SET_DEST (xexpr), new_dest, true);
1197 }
1198 }
1199 }
1200
1201 /* Simplify INSN. Remove all {PRE,POST}_{INC,DEC,MODIFY} rtxes,
1202 replace them with their value in the insn and add the side-effects
1203 as other sets to the insn. */
1204
1205 static void
1206 adjust_insn (basic_block bb, rtx_insn *insn)
1207 {
1208 rtx set;
1209
1210 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
1211 /* If the target machine has an explicit window save instruction, the
1212 transformation OUTGOING_REGNO -> INCOMING_REGNO is done there. */
1213 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn)
1214 && find_reg_note (insn, REG_CFA_WINDOW_SAVE, NULL_RTX))
1215 {
1216 unsigned int i, nregs = vec_safe_length (windowed_parm_regs);
1217 rtx rtl = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (nregs * 2));
1218 parm_reg *p;
1219
1220 FOR_EACH_VEC_SAFE_ELT (windowed_parm_regs, i, p)
1221 {
1222 XVECEXP (rtl, 0, i * 2)
1223 = gen_rtx_SET (p->incoming, p->outgoing);
1224 /* Do not clobber the attached DECL, but only the REG. */
1225 XVECEXP (rtl, 0, i * 2 + 1)
1226 = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (GET_MODE (p->outgoing),
1227 gen_raw_REG (GET_MODE (p->outgoing),
1228 REGNO (p->outgoing)));
1229 }
1230
1231 validate_change (NULL_RTX, &PATTERN (insn), rtl, true);
1232 return;
1233 }
1234 #endif
1235
1236 adjust_mem_data amd;
1237 amd.mem_mode = VOIDmode;
1238 amd.stack_adjust = -VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust;
1239
1240 amd.store = true;
1241 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), adjust_mem_stores, &amd);
1242
1243 amd.store = false;
1244 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1245 && asm_noperands (PATTERN (insn)) > 0
1246 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)) == SET)
1247 {
1248 rtx body, set0;
1249 int i;
1250
1251 /* inline-asm with multiple sets is tiny bit more complicated,
1252 because the 3 vectors in ASM_OPERANDS need to be shared between
1253 all ASM_OPERANDS in the instruction. adjust_mems will
1254 not touch ASM_OPERANDS other than the first one, asm_noperands
1255 test above needs to be called before that (otherwise it would fail)
1256 and afterwards this code fixes it up. */
1257 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn), adjust_mem_uses, &amd);
1258 body = PATTERN (insn);
1259 set0 = XVECEXP (body, 0, 0);
1260 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (set0) == SET
1261 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set0)) == ASM_OPERANDS
1262 && ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (SET_SRC (set0)) == 0);
1263 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (body, 0); i++)
1264 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)) != SET)
1265 break;
1266 else
1267 {
1268 set = XVECEXP (body, 0, i);
1269 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == ASM_OPERANDS
1270 && ASM_OPERANDS_OUTPUT_IDX (SET_SRC (set))
1271 == i);
1272 if (ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set))
1273 != ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0))
1274 || ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set))
1275 != ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0))
1276 || ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set))
1277 != ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set0)))
1278 {
1279 rtx newsrc = shallow_copy_rtx (SET_SRC (set));
1280 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (newsrc)
1281 = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0));
1282 ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (newsrc)
1283 = ASM_OPERANDS_INPUT_CONSTRAINT_VEC (SET_SRC (set0));
1284 ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (newsrc)
1285 = ASM_OPERANDS_LABEL_VEC (SET_SRC (set0));
1286 validate_change (NULL_RTX, &SET_SRC (set), newsrc, true);
1287 }
1288 }
1289 }
1290 else
1291 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn), adjust_mem_uses, &amd);
1292
1293 /* For read-only MEMs containing some constant, prefer those
1294 constants. */
1295 set = single_set (insn);
1296 if (set && MEM_P (SET_SRC (set)) && MEM_READONLY_P (SET_SRC (set)))
1297 {
1298 rtx note = find_reg_equal_equiv_note (insn);
1299
1300 if (note && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (note, 0)))
1301 validate_change (NULL_RTX, &SET_SRC (set), XEXP (note, 0), true);
1302 }
1303
1304 if (!amd.side_effects.is_empty ())
1305 {
1306 rtx *pat, new_pat;
1307 int i, oldn;
1308
1309 pat = &PATTERN (insn);
1310 if (GET_CODE (*pat) == COND_EXEC)
1311 pat = &COND_EXEC_CODE (*pat);
1312 if (GET_CODE (*pat) == PARALLEL)
1313 oldn = XVECLEN (*pat, 0);
1314 else
1315 oldn = 1;
1316 unsigned int newn = amd.side_effects.length ();
1317 new_pat = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (oldn + newn));
1318 if (GET_CODE (*pat) == PARALLEL)
1319 for (i = 0; i < oldn; i++)
1320 XVECEXP (new_pat, 0, i) = XVECEXP (*pat, 0, i);
1321 else
1322 XVECEXP (new_pat, 0, 0) = *pat;
1323
1324 rtx effect;
1325 unsigned int j;
1326 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT_REVERSE (amd.side_effects, j, effect)
1327 XVECEXP (new_pat, 0, j + oldn) = effect;
1328 validate_change (NULL_RTX, pat, new_pat, true);
1329 }
1330 }
1331
1332 /* Return the DEBUG_EXPR of a DEBUG_EXPR_DECL or the VALUE in DV. */
1333 static inline rtx
1334 dv_as_rtx (decl_or_value dv)
1335 {
1336 tree decl;
1337
1338 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
1339 return dv_as_value (dv);
1340
1341 decl = dv_as_decl (dv);
1342
1343 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL);
1344 return DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (decl);
1345 }
1346
1347 /* Return nonzero if a decl_or_value must not have more than one
1348 variable part. The returned value discriminates among various
1349 kinds of one-part DVs ccording to enum onepart_enum. */
1350 static inline onepart_enum
1351 dv_onepart_p (decl_or_value dv)
1352 {
1353 tree decl;
1354
1355 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
1356 return NOT_ONEPART;
1357
1358 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
1359 return ONEPART_VALUE;
1360
1361 decl = dv_as_decl (dv);
1362
1363 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL)
1364 return ONEPART_DEXPR;
1365
1366 if (target_for_debug_bind (decl) != NULL_TREE)
1367 return ONEPART_VDECL;
1368
1369 return NOT_ONEPART;
1370 }
1371
1372 /* Return the variable pool to be used for a dv of type ONEPART. */
1373 static inline pool_allocator &
1374 onepart_pool (onepart_enum onepart)
1375 {
1376 return onepart ? valvar_pool : var_pool;
1377 }
1378
1379 /* Allocate a variable_def from the corresponding variable pool. */
1380 static inline variable *
1381 onepart_pool_allocate (onepart_enum onepart)
1382 {
1383 return (variable*) onepart_pool (onepart).allocate ();
1384 }
1385
1386 /* Build a decl_or_value out of a decl. */
1387 static inline decl_or_value
1388 dv_from_decl (tree decl)
1389 {
1390 decl_or_value dv;
1391 dv = decl;
1392 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_decl_p (dv));
1393 return dv;
1394 }
1395
1396 /* Build a decl_or_value out of a value. */
1397 static inline decl_or_value
1398 dv_from_value (rtx value)
1399 {
1400 decl_or_value dv;
1401 dv = value;
1402 gcc_checking_assert (dv_is_value_p (dv));
1403 return dv;
1404 }
1405
1406 /* Return a value or the decl of a debug_expr as a decl_or_value. */
1407 static inline decl_or_value
1408 dv_from_rtx (rtx x)
1409 {
1410 decl_or_value dv;
1411
1412 switch (GET_CODE (x))
1413 {
1414 case DEBUG_EXPR:
1415 dv = dv_from_decl (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x));
1416 gcc_checking_assert (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x)) == x);
1417 break;
1418
1419 case VALUE:
1420 dv = dv_from_value (x);
1421 break;
1422
1423 default:
1424 gcc_unreachable ();
1425 }
1426
1427 return dv;
1428 }
1429
1430 extern void debug_dv (decl_or_value dv);
1431
1432 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
1433 debug_dv (decl_or_value dv)
1434 {
1435 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
1436 debug_rtx (dv_as_value (dv));
1437 else
1438 debug_generic_stmt (dv_as_decl (dv));
1439 }
1440
1441 static void loc_exp_dep_clear (variable *var);
1442
1443 /* Free the element of VARIABLE_HTAB (its type is struct variable_def). */
1444
1445 static void
1446 variable_htab_free (void *elem)
1447 {
1448 int i;
1449 variable *var = (variable *) elem;
1450 location_chain *node, *next;
1451
1452 gcc_checking_assert (var->refcount > 0);
1453
1454 var->refcount--;
1455 if (var->refcount > 0)
1456 return;
1457
1458 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
1459 {
1460 for (node = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = next)
1461 {
1462 next = node->next;
1463 delete node;
1464 }
1465 var->var_part[i].loc_chain = NULL;
1466 }
1467 if (var->onepart && VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
1468 {
1469 loc_exp_dep_clear (var);
1470 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var))
1471 VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var)->pprev = NULL;
1472 XDELETE (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var));
1473 /* These may be reused across functions, so reset
1474 e.g. NO_LOC_P. */
1475 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR)
1476 set_dv_changed (var->dv, true);
1477 }
1478 onepart_pool (var->onepart).remove (var);
1479 }
1480
1481 /* Initialize the set (array) SET of attrs to empty lists. */
1482
1483 static void
1484 init_attrs_list_set (attrs **set)
1485 {
1486 int i;
1487
1488 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
1489 set[i] = NULL;
1490 }
1491
1492 /* Make the list *LISTP empty. */
1493
1494 static void
1495 attrs_list_clear (attrs **listp)
1496 {
1497 attrs *list, *next;
1498
1499 for (list = *listp; list; list = next)
1500 {
1501 next = list->next;
1502 delete list;
1503 }
1504 *listp = NULL;
1505 }
1506
1507 /* Return true if the pair of DECL and OFFSET is the member of the LIST. */
1508
1509 static attrs *
1510 attrs_list_member (attrs *list, decl_or_value dv, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1511 {
1512 for (; list; list = list->next)
1513 if (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv) && list->offset == offset)
1514 return list;
1515 return NULL;
1516 }
1517
1518 /* Insert the triplet DECL, OFFSET, LOC to the list *LISTP. */
1519
1520 static void
1521 attrs_list_insert (attrs **listp, decl_or_value dv,
1522 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, rtx loc)
1523 {
1524 attrs *list = new attrs;
1525 list->loc = loc;
1526 list->dv = dv;
1527 list->offset = offset;
1528 list->next = *listp;
1529 *listp = list;
1530 }
1531
1532 /* Copy all nodes from SRC and create a list *DSTP of the copies. */
1533
1534 static void
1535 attrs_list_copy (attrs **dstp, attrs *src)
1536 {
1537 attrs_list_clear (dstp);
1538 for (; src; src = src->next)
1539 {
1540 attrs *n = new attrs;
1541 n->loc = src->loc;
1542 n->dv = src->dv;
1543 n->offset = src->offset;
1544 n->next = *dstp;
1545 *dstp = n;
1546 }
1547 }
1548
1549 /* Add all nodes from SRC which are not in *DSTP to *DSTP. */
1550
1551 static void
1552 attrs_list_union (attrs **dstp, attrs *src)
1553 {
1554 for (; src; src = src->next)
1555 {
1556 if (!attrs_list_member (*dstp, src->dv, src->offset))
1557 attrs_list_insert (dstp, src->dv, src->offset, src->loc);
1558 }
1559 }
1560
1561 /* Combine nodes that are not onepart nodes from SRC and SRC2 into
1562 *DSTP. */
1563
1564 static void
1565 attrs_list_mpdv_union (attrs **dstp, attrs *src, attrs *src2)
1566 {
1567 gcc_assert (!*dstp);
1568 for (; src; src = src->next)
1569 {
1570 if (!dv_onepart_p (src->dv))
1571 attrs_list_insert (dstp, src->dv, src->offset, src->loc);
1572 }
1573 for (src = src2; src; src = src->next)
1574 {
1575 if (!dv_onepart_p (src->dv)
1576 && !attrs_list_member (*dstp, src->dv, src->offset))
1577 attrs_list_insert (dstp, src->dv, src->offset, src->loc);
1578 }
1579 }
1580
1581 /* Shared hashtable support. */
1582
1583 /* Return true if VARS is shared. */
1584
1585 static inline bool
1586 shared_hash_shared (shared_hash *vars)
1587 {
1588 return vars->refcount > 1;
1589 }
1590
1591 /* Return the hash table for VARS. */
1592
1593 static inline variable_table_type *
1594 shared_hash_htab (shared_hash *vars)
1595 {
1596 return vars->htab;
1597 }
1598
1599 /* Return true if VAR is shared, or maybe because VARS is shared. */
1600
1601 static inline bool
1602 shared_var_p (variable *var, shared_hash *vars)
1603 {
1604 /* Don't count an entry in the changed_variables table as a duplicate. */
1605 return ((var->refcount > 1 + (int) var->in_changed_variables)
1606 || shared_hash_shared (vars));
1607 }
1608
1609 /* Copy variables into a new hash table. */
1610
1611 static shared_hash *
1612 shared_hash_unshare (shared_hash *vars)
1613 {
1614 shared_hash *new_vars = new shared_hash;
1615 gcc_assert (vars->refcount > 1);
1616 new_vars->refcount = 1;
1617 new_vars->htab = new variable_table_type (vars->htab->elements () + 3);
1618 vars_copy (new_vars->htab, vars->htab);
1619 vars->refcount--;
1620 return new_vars;
1621 }
1622
1623 /* Increment reference counter on VARS and return it. */
1624
1625 static inline shared_hash *
1626 shared_hash_copy (shared_hash *vars)
1627 {
1628 vars->refcount++;
1629 return vars;
1630 }
1631
1632 /* Decrement reference counter and destroy hash table if not shared
1633 anymore. */
1634
1635 static void
1636 shared_hash_destroy (shared_hash *vars)
1637 {
1638 gcc_checking_assert (vars->refcount > 0);
1639 if (--vars->refcount == 0)
1640 {
1641 delete vars->htab;
1642 delete vars;
1643 }
1644 }
1645
1646 /* Unshare *PVARS if shared and return slot for DV. If INS is
1647 INSERT, insert it if not already present. */
1648
1649 static inline variable **
1650 shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (shared_hash **pvars, decl_or_value dv,
1651 hashval_t dvhash, enum insert_option ins)
1652 {
1653 if (shared_hash_shared (*pvars))
1654 *pvars = shared_hash_unshare (*pvars);
1655 return shared_hash_htab (*pvars)->find_slot_with_hash (dv, dvhash, ins);
1656 }
1657
1658 static inline variable **
1659 shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (shared_hash **pvars, decl_or_value dv,
1660 enum insert_option ins)
1661 {
1662 return shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (pvars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv), ins);
1663 }
1664
1665 /* Return slot for DV, if it is already present in the hash table.
1666 If it is not present, insert it only VARS is not shared, otherwise
1667 return NULL. */
1668
1669 static inline variable **
1670 shared_hash_find_slot_1 (shared_hash *vars, decl_or_value dv, hashval_t dvhash)
1671 {
1672 return shared_hash_htab (vars)->find_slot_with_hash (dv, dvhash,
1673 shared_hash_shared (vars)
1674 ? NO_INSERT : INSERT);
1675 }
1676
1677 static inline variable **
1678 shared_hash_find_slot (shared_hash *vars, decl_or_value dv)
1679 {
1680 return shared_hash_find_slot_1 (vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
1681 }
1682
1683 /* Return slot for DV only if it is already present in the hash table. */
1684
1685 static inline variable **
1686 shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (shared_hash *vars, decl_or_value dv,
1687 hashval_t dvhash)
1688 {
1689 return shared_hash_htab (vars)->find_slot_with_hash (dv, dvhash, NO_INSERT);
1690 }
1691
1692 static inline variable **
1693 shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (shared_hash *vars, decl_or_value dv)
1694 {
1695 return shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
1696 }
1697
1698 /* Return variable for DV or NULL if not already present in the hash
1699 table. */
1700
1701 static inline variable *
1702 shared_hash_find_1 (shared_hash *vars, decl_or_value dv, hashval_t dvhash)
1703 {
1704 return shared_hash_htab (vars)->find_with_hash (dv, dvhash);
1705 }
1706
1707 static inline variable *
1708 shared_hash_find (shared_hash *vars, decl_or_value dv)
1709 {
1710 return shared_hash_find_1 (vars, dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
1711 }
1712
1713 /* Return true if TVAL is better than CVAL as a canonival value. We
1714 choose lowest-numbered VALUEs, using the RTX address as a
1715 tie-breaker. The idea is to arrange them into a star topology,
1716 such that all of them are at most one step away from the canonical
1717 value, and the canonical value has backlinks to all of them, in
1718 addition to all the actual locations. We don't enforce this
1719 topology throughout the entire dataflow analysis, though.
1720 */
1721
1722 static inline bool
1723 canon_value_cmp (rtx tval, rtx cval)
1724 {
1725 return !cval
1726 || CSELIB_VAL_PTR (tval)->uid < CSELIB_VAL_PTR (cval)->uid;
1727 }
1728
1729 static bool dst_can_be_shared;
1730
1731 /* Return a copy of a variable VAR and insert it to dataflow set SET. */
1732
1733 static variable **
1734 unshare_variable (dataflow_set *set, variable **slot, variable *var,
1735 enum var_init_status initialized)
1736 {
1737 variable *new_var;
1738 int i;
1739
1740 new_var = onepart_pool_allocate (var->onepart);
1741 new_var->dv = var->dv;
1742 new_var->refcount = 1;
1743 var->refcount--;
1744 new_var->n_var_parts = var->n_var_parts;
1745 new_var->onepart = var->onepart;
1746 new_var->in_changed_variables = false;
1747
1748 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
1749 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
1750
1751 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
1752 {
1753 location_chain *node;
1754 location_chain **nextp;
1755
1756 if (i == 0 && var->onepart)
1757 {
1758 /* One-part auxiliary data is only used while emitting
1759 notes, so propagate it to the new variable in the active
1760 dataflow set. If we're not emitting notes, this will be
1761 a no-op. */
1762 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) || emit_notes);
1763 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var);
1764 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = NULL;
1765 }
1766 else
1767 VAR_PART_OFFSET (new_var, i) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, i);
1768 nextp = &new_var->var_part[i].loc_chain;
1769 for (node = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
1770 {
1771 location_chain *new_lc;
1772
1773 new_lc = new location_chain;
1774 new_lc->next = NULL;
1775 if (node->init > initialized)
1776 new_lc->init = node->init;
1777 else
1778 new_lc->init = initialized;
1779 if (node->set_src && !(MEM_P (node->set_src)))
1780 new_lc->set_src = node->set_src;
1781 else
1782 new_lc->set_src = NULL;
1783 new_lc->loc = node->loc;
1784
1785 *nextp = new_lc;
1786 nextp = &new_lc->next;
1787 }
1788
1789 new_var->var_part[i].cur_loc = var->var_part[i].cur_loc;
1790 }
1791
1792 dst_can_be_shared = false;
1793 if (shared_hash_shared (set->vars))
1794 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set->vars, var->dv, NO_INSERT);
1795 else if (set->traversed_vars && set->vars != set->traversed_vars)
1796 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, var->dv);
1797 *slot = new_var;
1798 if (var->in_changed_variables)
1799 {
1800 variable **cslot
1801 = changed_variables->find_slot_with_hash (var->dv,
1802 dv_htab_hash (var->dv),
1803 NO_INSERT);
1804 gcc_assert (*cslot == (void *) var);
1805 var->in_changed_variables = false;
1806 variable_htab_free (var);
1807 *cslot = new_var;
1808 new_var->in_changed_variables = true;
1809 }
1810 return slot;
1811 }
1812
1813 /* Copy all variables from hash table SRC to hash table DST. */
1814
1815 static void
1816 vars_copy (variable_table_type *dst, variable_table_type *src)
1817 {
1818 variable_iterator_type hi;
1819 variable *var;
1820
1821 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*src, var, variable, hi)
1822 {
1823 variable **dstp;
1824 var->refcount++;
1825 dstp = dst->find_slot_with_hash (var->dv, dv_htab_hash (var->dv),
1826 INSERT);
1827 *dstp = var;
1828 }
1829 }
1830
1831 /* Map a decl to its main debug decl. */
1832
1833 static inline tree
1834 var_debug_decl (tree decl)
1835 {
1836 if (decl && VAR_P (decl) && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (decl))
1837 {
1838 tree debugdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
1839 if (DECL_P (debugdecl))
1840 decl = debugdecl;
1841 }
1842
1843 return decl;
1844 }
1845
1846 /* Set the register LOC to contain DV, OFFSET. */
1847
1848 static void
1849 var_reg_decl_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, enum var_init_status initialized,
1850 decl_or_value dv, HOST_WIDE_INT offset, rtx set_src,
1851 enum insert_option iopt)
1852 {
1853 attrs *node;
1854 bool decl_p = dv_is_decl_p (dv);
1855
1856 if (decl_p)
1857 dv = dv_from_decl (var_debug_decl (dv_as_decl (dv)));
1858
1859 for (node = set->regs[REGNO (loc)]; node; node = node->next)
1860 if (dv_as_opaque (node->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv)
1861 && node->offset == offset)
1862 break;
1863 if (!node)
1864 attrs_list_insert (&set->regs[REGNO (loc)], dv, offset, loc);
1865 set_variable_part (set, loc, dv, offset, initialized, set_src, iopt);
1866 }
1867
1868 /* Return true if we should track a location that is OFFSET bytes from
1869 a variable. Store the constant offset in *OFFSET_OUT if so. */
1870
1871 static bool
1872 track_offset_p (poly_int64 offset, HOST_WIDE_INT *offset_out)
1873 {
1874 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
1875 if (!offset.is_constant (&const_offset)
1876 || !IN_RANGE (const_offset, 0, MAX_VAR_PARTS - 1))
1877 return false;
1878 *offset_out = const_offset;
1879 return true;
1880 }
1881
1882 /* Return the offset of a register that track_offset_p says we
1883 should track. */
1884
1885 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1886 get_tracked_reg_offset (rtx loc)
1887 {
1888 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1889 if (!track_offset_p (REG_OFFSET (loc), &offset))
1890 gcc_unreachable ();
1891 return offset;
1892 }
1893
1894 /* Set the register to contain REG_EXPR (LOC), REG_OFFSET (LOC). */
1895
1896 static void
1897 var_reg_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, enum var_init_status initialized,
1898 rtx set_src)
1899 {
1900 tree decl = REG_EXPR (loc);
1901 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = get_tracked_reg_offset (loc);
1902
1903 var_reg_decl_set (set, loc, initialized,
1904 dv_from_decl (decl), offset, set_src, INSERT);
1905 }
1906
1907 static enum var_init_status
1908 get_init_value (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, decl_or_value dv)
1909 {
1910 variable *var;
1911 int i;
1912 enum var_init_status ret_val = VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN;
1913
1914 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
1915 return VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
1916
1917 var = shared_hash_find (set->vars, dv);
1918 if (var)
1919 {
1920 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts && ret_val == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN; i++)
1921 {
1922 location_chain *nextp;
1923 for (nextp = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; nextp; nextp = nextp->next)
1924 if (rtx_equal_p (nextp->loc, loc))
1925 {
1926 ret_val = nextp->init;
1927 break;
1928 }
1929 }
1930 }
1931
1932 return ret_val;
1933 }
1934
1935 /* Delete current content of register LOC in dataflow set SET and set
1936 the register to contain REG_EXPR (LOC), REG_OFFSET (LOC). If
1937 MODIFY is true, any other live copies of the same variable part are
1938 also deleted from the dataflow set, otherwise the variable part is
1939 assumed to be copied from another location holding the same
1940 part. */
1941
1942 static void
1943 var_reg_delete_and_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, bool modify,
1944 enum var_init_status initialized, rtx set_src)
1945 {
1946 tree decl = REG_EXPR (loc);
1947 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = get_tracked_reg_offset (loc);
1948 attrs *node, *next;
1949 attrs **nextp;
1950
1951 decl = var_debug_decl (decl);
1952
1953 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN)
1954 initialized = get_init_value (set, loc, dv_from_decl (decl));
1955
1956 nextp = &set->regs[REGNO (loc)];
1957 for (node = *nextp; node; node = next)
1958 {
1959 next = node->next;
1960 if (dv_as_opaque (node->dv) != decl || node->offset != offset)
1961 {
1962 delete_variable_part (set, node->loc, node->dv, node->offset);
1963 delete node;
1964 *nextp = next;
1965 }
1966 else
1967 {
1968 node->loc = loc;
1969 nextp = &node->next;
1970 }
1971 }
1972 if (modify)
1973 clobber_variable_part (set, loc, dv_from_decl (decl), offset, set_src);
1974 var_reg_set (set, loc, initialized, set_src);
1975 }
1976
1977 /* Delete the association of register LOC in dataflow set SET with any
1978 variables that aren't onepart. If CLOBBER is true, also delete any
1979 other live copies of the same variable part, and delete the
1980 association with onepart dvs too. */
1981
1982 static void
1983 var_reg_delete (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, bool clobber)
1984 {
1985 attrs **nextp = &set->regs[REGNO (loc)];
1986 attrs *node, *next;
1987
1988 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1989 if (clobber && track_offset_p (REG_OFFSET (loc), &offset))
1990 {
1991 tree decl = REG_EXPR (loc);
1992
1993 decl = var_debug_decl (decl);
1994
1995 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL, dv_from_decl (decl), offset, NULL);
1996 }
1997
1998 for (node = *nextp; node; node = next)
1999 {
2000 next = node->next;
2001 if (clobber || !dv_onepart_p (node->dv))
2002 {
2003 delete_variable_part (set, node->loc, node->dv, node->offset);
2004 delete node;
2005 *nextp = next;
2006 }
2007 else
2008 nextp = &node->next;
2009 }
2010 }
2011
2012 /* Delete content of register with number REGNO in dataflow set SET. */
2013
2014 static void
2015 var_regno_delete (dataflow_set *set, int regno)
2016 {
2017 attrs **reg = &set->regs[regno];
2018 attrs *node, *next;
2019
2020 for (node = *reg; node; node = next)
2021 {
2022 next = node->next;
2023 delete_variable_part (set, node->loc, node->dv, node->offset);
2024 delete node;
2025 }
2026 *reg = NULL;
2027 }
2028
2029 /* Return true if I is the negated value of a power of two. */
2030 static bool
2031 negative_power_of_two_p (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
2032 {
2033 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT x = -(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)i;
2034 return pow2_or_zerop (x);
2035 }
2036
2037 /* Strip constant offsets and alignments off of LOC. Return the base
2038 expression. */
2039
2040 static rtx
2041 vt_get_canonicalize_base (rtx loc)
2042 {
2043 while ((GET_CODE (loc) == PLUS
2044 || GET_CODE (loc) == AND)
2045 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc, 1)) == CONST_INT
2046 && (GET_CODE (loc) != AND
2047 || negative_power_of_two_p (INTVAL (XEXP (loc, 1)))))
2048 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
2049
2050 return loc;
2051 }
2052
2053 /* This caches canonicalized addresses for VALUEs, computed using
2054 information in the global cselib table. */
2055 static hash_map<rtx, rtx> *global_get_addr_cache;
2056
2057 /* This caches canonicalized addresses for VALUEs, computed using
2058 information from the global cache and information pertaining to a
2059 basic block being analyzed. */
2060 static hash_map<rtx, rtx> *local_get_addr_cache;
2061
2062 static rtx vt_canonicalize_addr (dataflow_set *, rtx);
2063
2064 /* Return the canonical address for LOC, that must be a VALUE, using a
2065 cached global equivalence or computing it and storing it in the
2066 global cache. */
2067
2068 static rtx
2069 get_addr_from_global_cache (rtx const loc)
2070 {
2071 rtx x;
2072
2073 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc) == VALUE);
2074
2075 bool existed;
2076 rtx *slot = &global_get_addr_cache->get_or_insert (loc, &existed);
2077 if (existed)
2078 return *slot;
2079
2080 x = canon_rtx (get_addr (loc));
2081
2082 /* Tentative, avoiding infinite recursion. */
2083 *slot = x;
2084
2085 if (x != loc)
2086 {
2087 rtx nx = vt_canonicalize_addr (NULL, x);
2088 if (nx != x)
2089 {
2090 /* The table may have moved during recursion, recompute
2091 SLOT. */
2092 *global_get_addr_cache->get (loc) = x = nx;
2093 }
2094 }
2095
2096 return x;
2097 }
2098
2099 /* Return the canonical address for LOC, that must be a VALUE, using a
2100 cached local equivalence or computing it and storing it in the
2101 local cache. */
2102
2103 static rtx
2104 get_addr_from_local_cache (dataflow_set *set, rtx const loc)
2105 {
2106 rtx x;
2107 decl_or_value dv;
2108 variable *var;
2109 location_chain *l;
2110
2111 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc) == VALUE);
2112
2113 bool existed;
2114 rtx *slot = &local_get_addr_cache->get_or_insert (loc, &existed);
2115 if (existed)
2116 return *slot;
2117
2118 x = get_addr_from_global_cache (loc);
2119
2120 /* Tentative, avoiding infinite recursion. */
2121 *slot = x;
2122
2123 /* Recurse to cache local expansion of X, or if we need to search
2124 for a VALUE in the expansion. */
2125 if (x != loc)
2126 {
2127 rtx nx = vt_canonicalize_addr (set, x);
2128 if (nx != x)
2129 {
2130 slot = local_get_addr_cache->get (loc);
2131 *slot = x = nx;
2132 }
2133 return x;
2134 }
2135
2136 dv = dv_from_rtx (x);
2137 var = shared_hash_find (set->vars, dv);
2138 if (!var)
2139 return x;
2140
2141 /* Look for an improved equivalent expression. */
2142 for (l = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; l; l = l->next)
2143 {
2144 rtx base = vt_get_canonicalize_base (l->loc);
2145 if (GET_CODE (base) == VALUE
2146 && canon_value_cmp (base, loc))
2147 {
2148 rtx nx = vt_canonicalize_addr (set, l->loc);
2149 if (x != nx)
2150 {
2151 slot = local_get_addr_cache->get (loc);
2152 *slot = x = nx;
2153 }
2154 break;
2155 }
2156 }
2157
2158 return x;
2159 }
2160
2161 /* Canonicalize LOC using equivalences from SET in addition to those
2162 in the cselib static table. It expects a VALUE-based expression,
2163 and it will only substitute VALUEs with other VALUEs or
2164 function-global equivalences, so that, if two addresses have base
2165 VALUEs that are locally or globally related in ways that
2166 memrefs_conflict_p cares about, they will both canonicalize to
2167 expressions that have the same base VALUE.
2168
2169 The use of VALUEs as canonical base addresses enables the canonical
2170 RTXs to remain unchanged globally, if they resolve to a constant,
2171 or throughout a basic block otherwise, so that they can be cached
2172 and the cache needs not be invalidated when REGs, MEMs or such
2173 change. */
2174
2175 static rtx
2176 vt_canonicalize_addr (dataflow_set *set, rtx oloc)
2177 {
2178 poly_int64 ofst = 0, term;
2179 machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (oloc);
2180 rtx loc = oloc;
2181 rtx x;
2182 bool retry = true;
2183
2184 while (retry)
2185 {
2186 while (GET_CODE (loc) == PLUS
2187 && poly_int_rtx_p (XEXP (loc, 1), &term))
2188 {
2189 ofst += term;
2190 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
2191 }
2192
2193 /* Alignment operations can't normally be combined, so just
2194 canonicalize the base and we're done. We'll normally have
2195 only one stack alignment anyway. */
2196 if (GET_CODE (loc) == AND
2197 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc, 1)) == CONST_INT
2198 && negative_power_of_two_p (INTVAL (XEXP (loc, 1))))
2199 {
2200 x = vt_canonicalize_addr (set, XEXP (loc, 0));
2201 if (x != XEXP (loc, 0))
2202 loc = gen_rtx_AND (mode, x, XEXP (loc, 1));
2203 retry = false;
2204 }
2205
2206 if (GET_CODE (loc) == VALUE)
2207 {
2208 if (set)
2209 loc = get_addr_from_local_cache (set, loc);
2210 else
2211 loc = get_addr_from_global_cache (loc);
2212
2213 /* Consolidate plus_constants. */
2214 while (maybe_ne (ofst, 0)
2215 && GET_CODE (loc) == PLUS
2216 && poly_int_rtx_p (XEXP (loc, 1), &term))
2217 {
2218 ofst += term;
2219 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
2220 }
2221
2222 retry = false;
2223 }
2224 else
2225 {
2226 x = canon_rtx (loc);
2227 if (retry)
2228 retry = (x != loc);
2229 loc = x;
2230 }
2231 }
2232
2233 /* Add OFST back in. */
2234 if (maybe_ne (ofst, 0))
2235 {
2236 /* Don't build new RTL if we can help it. */
2237 if (strip_offset (oloc, &term) == loc && known_eq (term, ofst))
2238 return oloc;
2239
2240 loc = plus_constant (mode, loc, ofst);
2241 }
2242
2243 return loc;
2244 }
2245
2246 /* Return true iff there's a true dependence between MLOC and LOC.
2247 MADDR must be a canonicalized version of MLOC's address. */
2248
2249 static inline bool
2250 vt_canon_true_dep (dataflow_set *set, rtx mloc, rtx maddr, rtx loc)
2251 {
2252 if (GET_CODE (loc) != MEM)
2253 return false;
2254
2255 rtx addr = vt_canonicalize_addr (set, XEXP (loc, 0));
2256 if (!canon_true_dependence (mloc, GET_MODE (mloc), maddr, loc, addr))
2257 return false;
2258
2259 return true;
2260 }
2261
2262 /* Hold parameters for the hashtab traversal function
2263 drop_overlapping_mem_locs, see below. */
2264
2265 struct overlapping_mems
2266 {
2267 dataflow_set *set;
2268 rtx loc, addr;
2269 };
2270
2271 /* Remove all MEMs that overlap with COMS->LOC from the location list
2272 of a hash table entry for a onepart variable. COMS->ADDR must be a
2273 canonicalized form of COMS->LOC's address, and COMS->LOC must be
2274 canonicalized itself. */
2275
2276 int
2277 drop_overlapping_mem_locs (variable **slot, overlapping_mems *coms)
2278 {
2279 dataflow_set *set = coms->set;
2280 rtx mloc = coms->loc, addr = coms->addr;
2281 variable *var = *slot;
2282
2283 if (var->onepart != NOT_ONEPART)
2284 {
2285 location_chain *loc, **locp;
2286 bool changed = false;
2287 rtx cur_loc;
2288
2289 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
2290
2291 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
2292 {
2293 for (loc = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; loc; loc = loc->next)
2294 if (vt_canon_true_dep (set, mloc, addr, loc->loc))
2295 break;
2296
2297 if (!loc)
2298 return 1;
2299
2300 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
2301 var = *slot;
2302 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
2303 }
2304
2305 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
2306 cur_loc = VAR_LOC_FROM (var);
2307 else
2308 cur_loc = var->var_part[0].cur_loc;
2309
2310 for (locp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain, loc = *locp;
2311 loc; loc = *locp)
2312 {
2313 if (!vt_canon_true_dep (set, mloc, addr, loc->loc))
2314 {
2315 locp = &loc->next;
2316 continue;
2317 }
2318
2319 *locp = loc->next;
2320 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
2321 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
2322 of changed variables. */
2323 if (cur_loc == loc->loc)
2324 {
2325 changed = true;
2326 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
2327 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
2328 VAR_LOC_FROM (var) = NULL;
2329 }
2330 delete loc;
2331 }
2332
2333 if (!var->var_part[0].loc_chain)
2334 {
2335 var->n_var_parts--;
2336 changed = true;
2337 }
2338 if (changed)
2339 variable_was_changed (var, set);
2340 }
2341
2342 return 1;
2343 }
2344
2345 /* Remove from SET all VALUE bindings to MEMs that overlap with LOC. */
2346
2347 static void
2348 clobber_overlapping_mems (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc)
2349 {
2350 struct overlapping_mems coms;
2351
2352 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc) == MEM);
2353
2354 coms.set = set;
2355 coms.loc = canon_rtx (loc);
2356 coms.addr = vt_canonicalize_addr (set, XEXP (loc, 0));
2357
2358 set->traversed_vars = set->vars;
2359 shared_hash_htab (set->vars)
2360 ->traverse <overlapping_mems*, drop_overlapping_mem_locs> (&coms);
2361 set->traversed_vars = NULL;
2362 }
2363
2364 /* Set the location of DV, OFFSET as the MEM LOC. */
2365
2366 static void
2367 var_mem_decl_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, enum var_init_status initialized,
2368 decl_or_value dv, HOST_WIDE_INT offset, rtx set_src,
2369 enum insert_option iopt)
2370 {
2371 if (dv_is_decl_p (dv))
2372 dv = dv_from_decl (var_debug_decl (dv_as_decl (dv)));
2373
2374 set_variable_part (set, loc, dv, offset, initialized, set_src, iopt);
2375 }
2376
2377 /* Set the location part of variable MEM_EXPR (LOC) in dataflow set
2378 SET to LOC.
2379 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
2380
2381 static void
2382 var_mem_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, enum var_init_status initialized,
2383 rtx set_src)
2384 {
2385 tree decl = MEM_EXPR (loc);
2386 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = int_mem_offset (loc);
2387
2388 var_mem_decl_set (set, loc, initialized,
2389 dv_from_decl (decl), offset, set_src, INSERT);
2390 }
2391
2392 /* Delete and set the location part of variable MEM_EXPR (LOC) in
2393 dataflow set SET to LOC. If MODIFY is true, any other live copies
2394 of the same variable part are also deleted from the dataflow set,
2395 otherwise the variable part is assumed to be copied from another
2396 location holding the same part.
2397 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
2398
2399 static void
2400 var_mem_delete_and_set (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, bool modify,
2401 enum var_init_status initialized, rtx set_src)
2402 {
2403 tree decl = MEM_EXPR (loc);
2404 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = int_mem_offset (loc);
2405
2406 clobber_overlapping_mems (set, loc);
2407 decl = var_debug_decl (decl);
2408
2409 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN)
2410 initialized = get_init_value (set, loc, dv_from_decl (decl));
2411
2412 if (modify)
2413 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL, dv_from_decl (decl), offset, set_src);
2414 var_mem_set (set, loc, initialized, set_src);
2415 }
2416
2417 /* Delete the location part LOC from dataflow set SET. If CLOBBER is
2418 true, also delete any other live copies of the same variable part.
2419 Adjust the address first if it is stack pointer based. */
2420
2421 static void
2422 var_mem_delete (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, bool clobber)
2423 {
2424 tree decl = MEM_EXPR (loc);
2425 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = int_mem_offset (loc);
2426
2427 clobber_overlapping_mems (set, loc);
2428 decl = var_debug_decl (decl);
2429 if (clobber)
2430 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL, dv_from_decl (decl), offset, NULL);
2431 delete_variable_part (set, loc, dv_from_decl (decl), offset);
2432 }
2433
2434 /* Return true if LOC should not be expanded for location expressions,
2435 or used in them. */
2436
2437 static inline bool
2438 unsuitable_loc (rtx loc)
2439 {
2440 switch (GET_CODE (loc))
2441 {
2442 case PC:
2443 case SCRATCH:
2444 case CC0:
2445 case ASM_INPUT:
2446 case ASM_OPERANDS:
2447 return true;
2448
2449 default:
2450 return false;
2451 }
2452 }
2453
2454 /* Bind VAL to LOC in SET. If MODIFIED, detach LOC from any values
2455 bound to it. */
2456
2457 static inline void
2458 val_bind (dataflow_set *set, rtx val, rtx loc, bool modified)
2459 {
2460 if (REG_P (loc))
2461 {
2462 if (modified)
2463 var_regno_delete (set, REGNO (loc));
2464 var_reg_decl_set (set, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
2465 dv_from_value (val), 0, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2466 }
2467 else if (MEM_P (loc))
2468 {
2469 struct elt_loc_list *l = CSELIB_VAL_PTR (val)->locs;
2470
2471 if (modified)
2472 clobber_overlapping_mems (set, loc);
2473
2474 if (l && GET_CODE (l->loc) == VALUE)
2475 l = canonical_cselib_val (CSELIB_VAL_PTR (l->loc))->locs;
2476
2477 /* If this MEM is a global constant, we don't need it in the
2478 dynamic tables. ??? We should test this before emitting the
2479 micro-op in the first place. */
2480 while (l)
2481 if (GET_CODE (l->loc) == MEM && XEXP (l->loc, 0) == XEXP (loc, 0))
2482 break;
2483 else
2484 l = l->next;
2485
2486 if (!l)
2487 var_mem_decl_set (set, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
2488 dv_from_value (val), 0, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2489 }
2490 else
2491 {
2492 /* Other kinds of equivalences are necessarily static, at least
2493 so long as we do not perform substitutions while merging
2494 expressions. */
2495 gcc_unreachable ();
2496 set_variable_part (set, loc, dv_from_value (val), 0,
2497 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2498 }
2499 }
2500
2501 /* Bind a value to a location it was just stored in. If MODIFIED
2502 holds, assume the location was modified, detaching it from any
2503 values bound to it. */
2504
2505 static void
2506 val_store (dataflow_set *set, rtx val, rtx loc, rtx_insn *insn,
2507 bool modified)
2508 {
2509 cselib_val *v = CSELIB_VAL_PTR (val);
2510
2511 gcc_assert (cselib_preserved_value_p (v));
2512
2513 if (dump_file)
2514 {
2515 fprintf (dump_file, "%i: ", insn ? INSN_UID (insn) : 0);
2516 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, loc, 0);
2517 fprintf (dump_file, " evaluates to ");
2518 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, val, 0);
2519 if (v->locs)
2520 {
2521 struct elt_loc_list *l;
2522 for (l = v->locs; l; l = l->next)
2523 {
2524 fprintf (dump_file, "\n%i: ", INSN_UID (l->setting_insn));
2525 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, l->loc, 0);
2526 }
2527 }
2528 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
2529 }
2530
2531 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc));
2532
2533 val_bind (set, val, loc, modified);
2534 }
2535
2536 /* Clear (canonical address) slots that reference X. */
2537
2538 bool
2539 local_get_addr_clear_given_value (rtx const &, rtx *slot, rtx x)
2540 {
2541 if (vt_get_canonicalize_base (*slot) == x)
2542 *slot = NULL;
2543 return true;
2544 }
2545
2546 /* Reset this node, detaching all its equivalences. Return the slot
2547 in the variable hash table that holds dv, if there is one. */
2548
2549 static void
2550 val_reset (dataflow_set *set, decl_or_value dv)
2551 {
2552 variable *var = shared_hash_find (set->vars, dv) ;
2553 location_chain *node;
2554 rtx cval;
2555
2556 if (!var || !var->n_var_parts)
2557 return;
2558
2559 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
2560
2561 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_VALUE)
2562 {
2563 rtx x = dv_as_value (dv);
2564
2565 /* Relationships in the global cache don't change, so reset the
2566 local cache entry only. */
2567 rtx *slot = local_get_addr_cache->get (x);
2568 if (slot)
2569 {
2570 /* If the value resolved back to itself, odds are that other
2571 values may have cached it too. These entries now refer
2572 to the old X, so detach them too. Entries that used the
2573 old X but resolved to something else remain ok as long as
2574 that something else isn't also reset. */
2575 if (*slot == x)
2576 local_get_addr_cache
2577 ->traverse<rtx, local_get_addr_clear_given_value> (x);
2578 *slot = NULL;
2579 }
2580 }
2581
2582 cval = NULL;
2583 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2584 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE
2585 && canon_value_cmp (node->loc, cval))
2586 cval = node->loc;
2587
2588 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2589 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE && cval != node->loc)
2590 {
2591 /* Redirect the equivalence link to the new canonical
2592 value, or simply remove it if it would point at
2593 itself. */
2594 if (cval)
2595 set_variable_part (set, cval, dv_from_value (node->loc),
2596 0, node->init, node->set_src, NO_INSERT);
2597 delete_variable_part (set, dv_as_value (dv),
2598 dv_from_value (node->loc), 0);
2599 }
2600
2601 if (cval)
2602 {
2603 decl_or_value cdv = dv_from_value (cval);
2604
2605 /* Keep the remaining values connected, accumulating links
2606 in the canonical value. */
2607 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2608 {
2609 if (node->loc == cval)
2610 continue;
2611 else if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == REG)
2612 var_reg_decl_set (set, node->loc, node->init, cdv, 0,
2613 node->set_src, NO_INSERT);
2614 else if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == MEM)
2615 var_mem_decl_set (set, node->loc, node->init, cdv, 0,
2616 node->set_src, NO_INSERT);
2617 else
2618 set_variable_part (set, node->loc, cdv, 0,
2619 node->init, node->set_src, NO_INSERT);
2620 }
2621 }
2622
2623 /* We remove this last, to make sure that the canonical value is not
2624 removed to the point of requiring reinsertion. */
2625 if (cval)
2626 delete_variable_part (set, dv_as_value (dv), dv_from_value (cval), 0);
2627
2628 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL, dv, 0, NULL);
2629 }
2630
2631 /* Find the values in a given location and map the val to another
2632 value, if it is unique, or add the location as one holding the
2633 value. */
2634
2635 static void
2636 val_resolve (dataflow_set *set, rtx val, rtx loc, rtx_insn *insn)
2637 {
2638 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_value (val);
2639
2640 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
2641 {
2642 if (insn)
2643 fprintf (dump_file, "%i: ", INSN_UID (insn));
2644 else
2645 fprintf (dump_file, "head: ");
2646 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, val, 0);
2647 fputs (" is at ", dump_file);
2648 print_inline_rtx (dump_file, loc, 0);
2649 fputc ('\n', dump_file);
2650 }
2651
2652 val_reset (set, dv);
2653
2654 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc));
2655
2656 if (REG_P (loc))
2657 {
2658 attrs *node, *found = NULL;
2659
2660 for (node = set->regs[REGNO (loc)]; node; node = node->next)
2661 if (dv_is_value_p (node->dv)
2662 && GET_MODE (dv_as_value (node->dv)) == GET_MODE (loc))
2663 {
2664 found = node;
2665
2666 /* Map incoming equivalences. ??? Wouldn't it be nice if
2667 we just started sharing the location lists? Maybe a
2668 circular list ending at the value itself or some
2669 such. */
2670 set_variable_part (set, dv_as_value (node->dv),
2671 dv_from_value (val), node->offset,
2672 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2673 set_variable_part (set, val, node->dv, node->offset,
2674 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX, INSERT);
2675 }
2676
2677 /* If we didn't find any equivalence, we need to remember that
2678 this value is held in the named register. */
2679 if (found)
2680 return;
2681 }
2682 /* ??? Attempt to find and merge equivalent MEMs or other
2683 expressions too. */
2684
2685 val_bind (set, val, loc, false);
2686 }
2687
2688 /* Initialize dataflow set SET to be empty.
2689 VARS_SIZE is the initial size of hash table VARS. */
2690
2691 static void
2692 dataflow_set_init (dataflow_set *set)
2693 {
2694 init_attrs_list_set (set->regs);
2695 set->vars = shared_hash_copy (empty_shared_hash);
2696 set->stack_adjust = 0;
2697 set->traversed_vars = NULL;
2698 }
2699
2700 /* Delete the contents of dataflow set SET. */
2701
2702 static void
2703 dataflow_set_clear (dataflow_set *set)
2704 {
2705 int i;
2706
2707 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
2708 attrs_list_clear (&set->regs[i]);
2709
2710 shared_hash_destroy (set->vars);
2711 set->vars = shared_hash_copy (empty_shared_hash);
2712 }
2713
2714 /* Copy the contents of dataflow set SRC to DST. */
2715
2716 static void
2717 dataflow_set_copy (dataflow_set *dst, dataflow_set *src)
2718 {
2719 int i;
2720
2721 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
2722 attrs_list_copy (&dst->regs[i], src->regs[i]);
2723
2724 shared_hash_destroy (dst->vars);
2725 dst->vars = shared_hash_copy (src->vars);
2726 dst->stack_adjust = src->stack_adjust;
2727 }
2728
2729 /* Information for merging lists of locations for a given offset of variable.
2730 */
2731 struct variable_union_info
2732 {
2733 /* Node of the location chain. */
2734 location_chain *lc;
2735
2736 /* The sum of positions in the input chains. */
2737 int pos;
2738
2739 /* The position in the chain of DST dataflow set. */
2740 int pos_dst;
2741 };
2742
2743 /* Buffer for location list sorting and its allocated size. */
2744 static struct variable_union_info *vui_vec;
2745 static int vui_allocated;
2746
2747 /* Compare function for qsort, order the structures by POS element. */
2748
2749 static int
2750 variable_union_info_cmp_pos (const void *n1, const void *n2)
2751 {
2752 const struct variable_union_info *const i1 =
2753 (const struct variable_union_info *) n1;
2754 const struct variable_union_info *const i2 =
2755 ( const struct variable_union_info *) n2;
2756
2757 if (i1->pos != i2->pos)
2758 return i1->pos - i2->pos;
2759
2760 return (i1->pos_dst - i2->pos_dst);
2761 }
2762
2763 /* Compute union of location parts of variable *SLOT and the same variable
2764 from hash table DATA. Compute "sorted" union of the location chains
2765 for common offsets, i.e. the locations of a variable part are sorted by
2766 a priority where the priority is the sum of the positions in the 2 chains
2767 (if a location is only in one list the position in the second list is
2768 defined to be larger than the length of the chains).
2769 When we are updating the location parts the newest location is in the
2770 beginning of the chain, so when we do the described "sorted" union
2771 we keep the newest locations in the beginning. */
2772
2773 static int
2774 variable_union (variable *src, dataflow_set *set)
2775 {
2776 variable *dst;
2777 variable **dstp;
2778 int i, j, k;
2779
2780 dstp = shared_hash_find_slot (set->vars, src->dv);
2781 if (!dstp || !*dstp)
2782 {
2783 src->refcount++;
2784
2785 dst_can_be_shared = false;
2786 if (!dstp)
2787 dstp = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set->vars, src->dv, INSERT);
2788
2789 *dstp = src;
2790
2791 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
2792 return 1;
2793 }
2794 else
2795 dst = *dstp;
2796
2797 gcc_assert (src->n_var_parts);
2798 gcc_checking_assert (src->onepart == dst->onepart);
2799
2800 /* We can combine one-part variables very efficiently, because their
2801 entries are in canonical order. */
2802 if (src->onepart)
2803 {
2804 location_chain **nodep, *dnode, *snode;
2805
2806 gcc_assert (src->n_var_parts == 1
2807 && dst->n_var_parts == 1);
2808
2809 snode = src->var_part[0].loc_chain;
2810 gcc_assert (snode);
2811
2812 restart_onepart_unshared:
2813 nodep = &dst->var_part[0].loc_chain;
2814 dnode = *nodep;
2815 gcc_assert (dnode);
2816
2817 while (snode)
2818 {
2819 int r = dnode ? loc_cmp (dnode->loc, snode->loc) : 1;
2820
2821 if (r > 0)
2822 {
2823 location_chain *nnode;
2824
2825 if (shared_var_p (dst, set->vars))
2826 {
2827 dstp = unshare_variable (set, dstp, dst,
2828 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
2829 dst = *dstp;
2830 goto restart_onepart_unshared;
2831 }
2832
2833 *nodep = nnode = new location_chain;
2834 nnode->loc = snode->loc;
2835 nnode->init = snode->init;
2836 if (!snode->set_src || MEM_P (snode->set_src))
2837 nnode->set_src = NULL;
2838 else
2839 nnode->set_src = snode->set_src;
2840 nnode->next = dnode;
2841 dnode = nnode;
2842 }
2843 else if (r == 0)
2844 gcc_checking_assert (rtx_equal_p (dnode->loc, snode->loc));
2845
2846 if (r >= 0)
2847 snode = snode->next;
2848
2849 nodep = &dnode->next;
2850 dnode = *nodep;
2851 }
2852
2853 return 1;
2854 }
2855
2856 gcc_checking_assert (!src->onepart);
2857
2858 /* Count the number of location parts, result is K. */
2859 for (i = 0, j = 0, k = 0;
2860 i < src->n_var_parts && j < dst->n_var_parts; k++)
2861 {
2862 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i) == VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j))
2863 {
2864 i++;
2865 j++;
2866 }
2867 else if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i) < VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j))
2868 i++;
2869 else
2870 j++;
2871 }
2872 k += src->n_var_parts - i;
2873 k += dst->n_var_parts - j;
2874
2875 /* We track only variables whose size is <= MAX_VAR_PARTS bytes
2876 thus there are at most MAX_VAR_PARTS different offsets. */
2877 gcc_checking_assert (dst->onepart ? k == 1 : k <= MAX_VAR_PARTS);
2878
2879 if (dst->n_var_parts != k && shared_var_p (dst, set->vars))
2880 {
2881 dstp = unshare_variable (set, dstp, dst, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
2882 dst = *dstp;
2883 }
2884
2885 i = src->n_var_parts - 1;
2886 j = dst->n_var_parts - 1;
2887 dst->n_var_parts = k;
2888
2889 for (k--; k >= 0; k--)
2890 {
2891 location_chain *node, *node2;
2892
2893 if (i >= 0 && j >= 0
2894 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i) == VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j))
2895 {
2896 /* Compute the "sorted" union of the chains, i.e. the locations which
2897 are in both chains go first, they are sorted by the sum of
2898 positions in the chains. */
2899 int dst_l, src_l;
2900 int ii, jj, n;
2901 struct variable_union_info *vui;
2902
2903 /* If DST is shared compare the location chains.
2904 If they are different we will modify the chain in DST with
2905 high probability so make a copy of DST. */
2906 if (shared_var_p (dst, set->vars))
2907 {
2908 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain,
2909 node2 = dst->var_part[j].loc_chain; node && node2;
2910 node = node->next, node2 = node2->next)
2911 {
2912 if (!((REG_P (node2->loc)
2913 && REG_P (node->loc)
2914 && REGNO (node2->loc) == REGNO (node->loc))
2915 || rtx_equal_p (node2->loc, node->loc)))
2916 {
2917 if (node2->init < node->init)
2918 node2->init = node->init;
2919 break;
2920 }
2921 }
2922 if (node || node2)
2923 {
2924 dstp = unshare_variable (set, dstp, dst,
2925 VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
2926 dst = (variable *)*dstp;
2927 }
2928 }
2929
2930 src_l = 0;
2931 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2932 src_l++;
2933 dst_l = 0;
2934 for (node = dst->var_part[j].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2935 dst_l++;
2936
2937 if (dst_l == 1)
2938 {
2939 /* The most common case, much simpler, no qsort is needed. */
2940 location_chain *dstnode = dst->var_part[j].loc_chain;
2941 dst->var_part[k].loc_chain = dstnode;
2942 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, k) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j);
2943 node2 = dstnode;
2944 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
2945 if (!((REG_P (dstnode->loc)
2946 && REG_P (node->loc)
2947 && REGNO (dstnode->loc) == REGNO (node->loc))
2948 || rtx_equal_p (dstnode->loc, node->loc)))
2949 {
2950 location_chain *new_node;
2951
2952 /* Copy the location from SRC. */
2953 new_node = new location_chain;
2954 new_node->loc = node->loc;
2955 new_node->init = node->init;
2956 if (!node->set_src || MEM_P (node->set_src))
2957 new_node->set_src = NULL;
2958 else
2959 new_node->set_src = node->set_src;
2960 node2->next = new_node;
2961 node2 = new_node;
2962 }
2963 node2->next = NULL;
2964 }
2965 else
2966 {
2967 if (src_l + dst_l > vui_allocated)
2968 {
2969 vui_allocated = MAX (vui_allocated * 2, src_l + dst_l);
2970 vui_vec = XRESIZEVEC (struct variable_union_info, vui_vec,
2971 vui_allocated);
2972 }
2973 vui = vui_vec;
2974
2975 /* Fill in the locations from DST. */
2976 for (node = dst->var_part[j].loc_chain, jj = 0; node;
2977 node = node->next, jj++)
2978 {
2979 vui[jj].lc = node;
2980 vui[jj].pos_dst = jj;
2981
2982 /* Pos plus value larger than a sum of 2 valid positions. */
2983 vui[jj].pos = jj + src_l + dst_l;
2984 }
2985
2986 /* Fill in the locations from SRC. */
2987 n = dst_l;
2988 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain, ii = 0; node;
2989 node = node->next, ii++)
2990 {
2991 /* Find location from NODE. */
2992 for (jj = 0; jj < dst_l; jj++)
2993 {
2994 if ((REG_P (vui[jj].lc->loc)
2995 && REG_P (node->loc)
2996 && REGNO (vui[jj].lc->loc) == REGNO (node->loc))
2997 || rtx_equal_p (vui[jj].lc->loc, node->loc))
2998 {
2999 vui[jj].pos = jj + ii;
3000 break;
3001 }
3002 }
3003 if (jj >= dst_l) /* The location has not been found. */
3004 {
3005 location_chain *new_node;
3006
3007 /* Copy the location from SRC. */
3008 new_node = new location_chain;
3009 new_node->loc = node->loc;
3010 new_node->init = node->init;
3011 if (!node->set_src || MEM_P (node->set_src))
3012 new_node->set_src = NULL;
3013 else
3014 new_node->set_src = node->set_src;
3015 vui[n].lc = new_node;
3016 vui[n].pos_dst = src_l + dst_l;
3017 vui[n].pos = ii + src_l + dst_l;
3018 n++;
3019 }
3020 }
3021
3022 if (dst_l == 2)
3023 {
3024 /* Special case still very common case. For dst_l == 2
3025 all entries dst_l ... n-1 are sorted, with for i >= dst_l
3026 vui[i].pos == i + src_l + dst_l. */
3027 if (vui[0].pos > vui[1].pos)
3028 {
3029 /* Order should be 1, 0, 2... */
3030 dst->var_part[k].loc_chain = vui[1].lc;
3031 vui[1].lc->next = vui[0].lc;
3032 if (n >= 3)
3033 {
3034 vui[0].lc->next = vui[2].lc;
3035 vui[n - 1].lc->next = NULL;
3036 }
3037 else
3038 vui[0].lc->next = NULL;
3039 ii = 3;
3040 }
3041 else
3042 {
3043 dst->var_part[k].loc_chain = vui[0].lc;
3044 if (n >= 3 && vui[2].pos < vui[1].pos)
3045 {
3046 /* Order should be 0, 2, 1, 3... */
3047 vui[0].lc->next = vui[2].lc;
3048 vui[2].lc->next = vui[1].lc;
3049 if (n >= 4)
3050 {
3051 vui[1].lc->next = vui[3].lc;
3052 vui[n - 1].lc->next = NULL;
3053 }
3054 else
3055 vui[1].lc->next = NULL;
3056 ii = 4;
3057 }
3058 else
3059 {
3060 /* Order should be 0, 1, 2... */
3061 ii = 1;
3062 vui[n - 1].lc->next = NULL;
3063 }
3064 }
3065 for (; ii < n; ii++)
3066 vui[ii - 1].lc->next = vui[ii].lc;
3067 }
3068 else
3069 {
3070 qsort (vui, n, sizeof (struct variable_union_info),
3071 variable_union_info_cmp_pos);
3072
3073 /* Reconnect the nodes in sorted order. */
3074 for (ii = 1; ii < n; ii++)
3075 vui[ii - 1].lc->next = vui[ii].lc;
3076 vui[n - 1].lc->next = NULL;
3077 dst->var_part[k].loc_chain = vui[0].lc;
3078 }
3079
3080 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, k) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j);
3081 }
3082 i--;
3083 j--;
3084 }
3085 else if ((i >= 0 && j >= 0
3086 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i) < VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j))
3087 || i < 0)
3088 {
3089 dst->var_part[k] = dst->var_part[j];
3090 j--;
3091 }
3092 else if ((i >= 0 && j >= 0
3093 && VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i) > VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, j))
3094 || j < 0)
3095 {
3096 location_chain **nextp;
3097
3098 /* Copy the chain from SRC. */
3099 nextp = &dst->var_part[k].loc_chain;
3100 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3101 {
3102 location_chain *new_lc;
3103
3104 new_lc = new location_chain;
3105 new_lc->next = NULL;
3106 new_lc->init = node->init;
3107 if (!node->set_src || MEM_P (node->set_src))
3108 new_lc->set_src = NULL;
3109 else
3110 new_lc->set_src = node->set_src;
3111 new_lc->loc = node->loc;
3112
3113 *nextp = new_lc;
3114 nextp = &new_lc->next;
3115 }
3116
3117 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dst, k) = VAR_PART_OFFSET (src, i);
3118 i--;
3119 }
3120 dst->var_part[k].cur_loc = NULL;
3121 }
3122
3123 if (flag_var_tracking_uninit)
3124 for (i = 0; i < src->n_var_parts && i < dst->n_var_parts; i++)
3125 {
3126 location_chain *node, *node2;
3127 for (node = src->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3128 for (node2 = dst->var_part[i].loc_chain; node2; node2 = node2->next)
3129 if (rtx_equal_p (node->loc, node2->loc))
3130 {
3131 if (node->init > node2->init)
3132 node2->init = node->init;
3133 }
3134 }
3135
3136 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
3137 return 1;
3138 }
3139
3140 /* Compute union of dataflow sets SRC and DST and store it to DST. */
3141
3142 static void
3143 dataflow_set_union (dataflow_set *dst, dataflow_set *src)
3144 {
3145 int i;
3146
3147 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
3148 attrs_list_union (&dst->regs[i], src->regs[i]);
3149
3150 if (dst->vars == empty_shared_hash)
3151 {
3152 shared_hash_destroy (dst->vars);
3153 dst->vars = shared_hash_copy (src->vars);
3154 }
3155 else
3156 {
3157 variable_iterator_type hi;
3158 variable *var;
3159
3160 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*shared_hash_htab (src->vars),
3161 var, variable, hi)
3162 variable_union (var, dst);
3163 }
3164 }
3165
3166 /* Whether the value is currently being expanded. */
3167 #define VALUE_RECURSED_INTO(x) \
3168 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK2 ("VALUE_RECURSED_INTO", (x), VALUE, DEBUG_EXPR)->used)
3169
3170 /* Whether no expansion was found, saving useless lookups.
3171 It must only be set when VALUE_CHANGED is clear. */
3172 #define NO_LOC_P(x) \
3173 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK2 ("NO_LOC_P", (x), VALUE, DEBUG_EXPR)->return_val)
3174
3175 /* Whether cur_loc in the value needs to be (re)computed. */
3176 #define VALUE_CHANGED(x) \
3177 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VALUE_CHANGED", (x), VALUE)->frame_related)
3178 /* Whether cur_loc in the decl needs to be (re)computed. */
3179 #define DECL_CHANGED(x) TREE_VISITED (x)
3180
3181 /* Record (if NEWV) that DV needs to have its cur_loc recomputed. For
3182 user DECLs, this means they're in changed_variables. Values and
3183 debug exprs may be left with this flag set if no user variable
3184 requires them to be evaluated. */
3185
3186 static inline void
3187 set_dv_changed (decl_or_value dv, bool newv)
3188 {
3189 switch (dv_onepart_p (dv))
3190 {
3191 case ONEPART_VALUE:
3192 if (newv)
3193 NO_LOC_P (dv_as_value (dv)) = false;
3194 VALUE_CHANGED (dv_as_value (dv)) = newv;
3195 break;
3196
3197 case ONEPART_DEXPR:
3198 if (newv)
3199 NO_LOC_P (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dv_as_decl (dv))) = false;
3200 /* Fall through. */
3201
3202 default:
3203 DECL_CHANGED (dv_as_decl (dv)) = newv;
3204 break;
3205 }
3206 }
3207
3208 /* Return true if DV needs to have its cur_loc recomputed. */
3209
3210 static inline bool
3211 dv_changed_p (decl_or_value dv)
3212 {
3213 return (dv_is_value_p (dv)
3214 ? VALUE_CHANGED (dv_as_value (dv))
3215 : DECL_CHANGED (dv_as_decl (dv)));
3216 }
3217
3218 /* Return a location list node whose loc is rtx_equal to LOC, in the
3219 location list of a one-part variable or value VAR, or in that of
3220 any values recursively mentioned in the location lists. VARS must
3221 be in star-canonical form. */
3222
3223 static location_chain *
3224 find_loc_in_1pdv (rtx loc, variable *var, variable_table_type *vars)
3225 {
3226 location_chain *node;
3227 enum rtx_code loc_code;
3228
3229 if (!var)
3230 return NULL;
3231
3232 gcc_checking_assert (var->onepart);
3233
3234 if (!var->n_var_parts)
3235 return NULL;
3236
3237 gcc_checking_assert (loc != dv_as_opaque (var->dv));
3238
3239 loc_code = GET_CODE (loc);
3240 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3241 {
3242 decl_or_value dv;
3243 variable *rvar;
3244
3245 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) != loc_code)
3246 {
3247 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) != VALUE)
3248 continue;
3249 }
3250 else if (loc == node->loc)
3251 return node;
3252 else if (loc_code != VALUE)
3253 {
3254 if (rtx_equal_p (loc, node->loc))
3255 return node;
3256 continue;
3257 }
3258
3259 /* Since we're in star-canonical form, we don't need to visit
3260 non-canonical nodes: one-part variables and non-canonical
3261 values would only point back to the canonical node. */
3262 if (dv_is_value_p (var->dv)
3263 && !canon_value_cmp (node->loc, dv_as_value (var->dv)))
3264 {
3265 /* Skip all subsequent VALUEs. */
3266 while (node->next && GET_CODE (node->next->loc) == VALUE)
3267 {
3268 node = node->next;
3269 gcc_checking_assert (!canon_value_cmp (node->loc,
3270 dv_as_value (var->dv)));
3271 if (loc == node->loc)
3272 return node;
3273 }
3274 continue;
3275 }
3276
3277 gcc_checking_assert (node == var->var_part[0].loc_chain);
3278 gcc_checking_assert (!node->next);
3279
3280 dv = dv_from_value (node->loc);
3281 rvar = vars->find_with_hash (dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
3282 return find_loc_in_1pdv (loc, rvar, vars);
3283 }
3284
3285 /* ??? Gotta look in cselib_val locations too. */
3286
3287 return NULL;
3288 }
3289
3290 /* Hash table iteration argument passed to variable_merge. */
3291 struct dfset_merge
3292 {
3293 /* The set in which the merge is to be inserted. */
3294 dataflow_set *dst;
3295 /* The set that we're iterating in. */
3296 dataflow_set *cur;
3297 /* The set that may contain the other dv we are to merge with. */
3298 dataflow_set *src;
3299 /* Number of onepart dvs in src. */
3300 int src_onepart_cnt;
3301 };
3302
3303 /* Insert LOC in *DNODE, if it's not there yet. The list must be in
3304 loc_cmp order, and it is maintained as such. */
3305
3306 static void
3307 insert_into_intersection (location_chain **nodep, rtx loc,
3308 enum var_init_status status)
3309 {
3310 location_chain *node;
3311 int r;
3312
3313 for (node = *nodep; node; nodep = &node->next, node = *nodep)
3314 if ((r = loc_cmp (node->loc, loc)) == 0)
3315 {
3316 node->init = MIN (node->init, status);
3317 return;
3318 }
3319 else if (r > 0)
3320 break;
3321
3322 node = new location_chain;
3323
3324 node->loc = loc;
3325 node->set_src = NULL;
3326 node->init = status;
3327 node->next = *nodep;
3328 *nodep = node;
3329 }
3330
3331 /* Insert in DEST the intersection of the locations present in both
3332 S1NODE and S2VAR, directly or indirectly. S1NODE is from a
3333 variable in DSM->cur, whereas S2VAR is from DSM->src. dvar is in
3334 DSM->dst. */
3335
3336 static void
3337 intersect_loc_chains (rtx val, location_chain **dest, struct dfset_merge *dsm,
3338 location_chain *s1node, variable *s2var)
3339 {
3340 dataflow_set *s1set = dsm->cur;
3341 dataflow_set *s2set = dsm->src;
3342 location_chain *found;
3343
3344 if (s2var)
3345 {
3346 location_chain *s2node;
3347
3348 gcc_checking_assert (s2var->onepart);
3349
3350 if (s2var->n_var_parts)
3351 {
3352 s2node = s2var->var_part[0].loc_chain;
3353
3354 for (; s1node && s2node;
3355 s1node = s1node->next, s2node = s2node->next)
3356 if (s1node->loc != s2node->loc)
3357 break;
3358 else if (s1node->loc == val)
3359 continue;
3360 else
3361 insert_into_intersection (dest, s1node->loc,
3362 MIN (s1node->init, s2node->init));
3363 }
3364 }
3365
3366 for (; s1node; s1node = s1node->next)
3367 {
3368 if (s1node->loc == val)
3369 continue;
3370
3371 if ((found = find_loc_in_1pdv (s1node->loc, s2var,
3372 shared_hash_htab (s2set->vars))))
3373 {
3374 insert_into_intersection (dest, s1node->loc,
3375 MIN (s1node->init, found->init));
3376 continue;
3377 }
3378
3379 if (GET_CODE (s1node->loc) == VALUE
3380 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node->loc))
3381 {
3382 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_value (s1node->loc);
3383 variable *svar = shared_hash_find (s1set->vars, dv);
3384 if (svar)
3385 {
3386 if (svar->n_var_parts == 1)
3387 {
3388 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node->loc) = true;
3389 intersect_loc_chains (val, dest, dsm,
3390 svar->var_part[0].loc_chain,
3391 s2var);
3392 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (s1node->loc) = false;
3393 }
3394 }
3395 }
3396
3397 /* ??? gotta look in cselib_val locations too. */
3398
3399 /* ??? if the location is equivalent to any location in src,
3400 searched recursively
3401
3402 add to dst the values needed to represent the equivalence
3403
3404 telling whether locations S is equivalent to another dv's
3405 location list:
3406
3407 for each location D in the list
3408
3409 if S and D satisfy rtx_equal_p, then it is present
3410
3411 else if D is a value, recurse without cycles
3412
3413 else if S and D have the same CODE and MODE
3414
3415 for each operand oS and the corresponding oD
3416
3417 if oS and oD are not equivalent, then S an D are not equivalent
3418
3419 else if they are RTX vectors
3420
3421 if any vector oS element is not equivalent to its respective oD,
3422 then S and D are not equivalent
3423
3424 */
3425
3426
3427 }
3428 }
3429
3430 /* Return -1 if X should be before Y in a location list for a 1-part
3431 variable, 1 if Y should be before X, and 0 if they're equivalent
3432 and should not appear in the list. */
3433
3434 static int
3435 loc_cmp (rtx x, rtx y)
3436 {
3437 int i, j, r;
3438 RTX_CODE code = GET_CODE (x);
3439 const char *fmt;
3440
3441 if (x == y)
3442 return 0;
3443
3444 if (REG_P (x))
3445 {
3446 if (!REG_P (y))
3447 return -1;
3448 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x) == GET_MODE (y));
3449 if (REGNO (x) == REGNO (y))
3450 return 0;
3451 else if (REGNO (x) < REGNO (y))
3452 return -1;
3453 else
3454 return 1;
3455 }
3456
3457 if (REG_P (y))
3458 return 1;
3459
3460 if (MEM_P (x))
3461 {
3462 if (!MEM_P (y))
3463 return -1;
3464 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x) == GET_MODE (y));
3465 return loc_cmp (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (y, 0));
3466 }
3467
3468 if (MEM_P (y))
3469 return 1;
3470
3471 if (GET_CODE (x) == VALUE)
3472 {
3473 if (GET_CODE (y) != VALUE)
3474 return -1;
3475 /* Don't assert the modes are the same, that is true only
3476 when not recursing. (subreg:QI (value:SI 1:1) 0)
3477 and (subreg:QI (value:DI 2:2) 0) can be compared,
3478 even when the modes are different. */
3479 if (canon_value_cmp (x, y))
3480 return -1;
3481 else
3482 return 1;
3483 }
3484
3485 if (GET_CODE (y) == VALUE)
3486 return 1;
3487
3488 /* Entry value is the least preferable kind of expression. */
3489 if (GET_CODE (x) == ENTRY_VALUE)
3490 {
3491 if (GET_CODE (y) != ENTRY_VALUE)
3492 return 1;
3493 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x) == GET_MODE (y));
3494 return loc_cmp (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (x), ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (y));
3495 }
3496
3497 if (GET_CODE (y) == ENTRY_VALUE)
3498 return -1;
3499
3500 if (GET_CODE (x) == GET_CODE (y))
3501 /* Compare operands below. */;
3502 else if (GET_CODE (x) < GET_CODE (y))
3503 return -1;
3504 else
3505 return 1;
3506
3507 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (x) == GET_MODE (y));
3508
3509 if (GET_CODE (x) == DEBUG_EXPR)
3510 {
3511 if (DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x))
3512 < DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (y)))
3513 return -1;
3514 gcc_checking_assert (DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (x))
3515 > DEBUG_TEMP_UID (DEBUG_EXPR_TREE_DECL (y)));
3516 return 1;
3517 }
3518
3519 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
3520 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++)
3521 switch (fmt[i])
3522 {
3523 case 'w':
3524 if (XWINT (x, i) == XWINT (y, i))
3525 break;
3526 else if (XWINT (x, i) < XWINT (y, i))
3527 return -1;
3528 else
3529 return 1;
3530
3531 case 'n':
3532 case 'i':
3533 if (XINT (x, i) == XINT (y, i))
3534 break;
3535 else if (XINT (x, i) < XINT (y, i))
3536 return -1;
3537 else
3538 return 1;
3539
3540 case 'p':
3541 r = compare_sizes_for_sort (SUBREG_BYTE (x), SUBREG_BYTE (y));
3542 if (r != 0)
3543 return r;
3544 break;
3545
3546 case 'V':
3547 case 'E':
3548 /* Compare the vector length first. */
3549 if (XVECLEN (x, i) == XVECLEN (y, i))
3550 /* Compare the vectors elements. */;
3551 else if (XVECLEN (x, i) < XVECLEN (y, i))
3552 return -1;
3553 else
3554 return 1;
3555
3556 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
3557 if ((r = loc_cmp (XVECEXP (x, i, j),
3558 XVECEXP (y, i, j))))
3559 return r;
3560 break;
3561
3562 case 'e':
3563 if ((r = loc_cmp (XEXP (x, i), XEXP (y, i))))
3564 return r;
3565 break;
3566
3567 case 'S':
3568 case 's':
3569 if (XSTR (x, i) == XSTR (y, i))
3570 break;
3571 if (!XSTR (x, i))
3572 return -1;
3573 if (!XSTR (y, i))
3574 return 1;
3575 if ((r = strcmp (XSTR (x, i), XSTR (y, i))) == 0)
3576 break;
3577 else if (r < 0)
3578 return -1;
3579 else
3580 return 1;
3581
3582 case 'u':
3583 /* These are just backpointers, so they don't matter. */
3584 break;
3585
3586 case '0':
3587 case 't':
3588 break;
3589
3590 /* It is believed that rtx's at this level will never
3591 contain anything but integers and other rtx's,
3592 except for within LABEL_REFs and SYMBOL_REFs. */
3593 default:
3594 gcc_unreachable ();
3595 }
3596 if (CONST_WIDE_INT_P (x))
3597 {
3598 /* Compare the vector length first. */
3599 if (CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (x) >= CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (y))
3600 return 1;
3601 else if (CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (x) < CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (y))
3602 return -1;
3603
3604 /* Compare the vectors elements. */;
3605 for (j = CONST_WIDE_INT_NUNITS (x) - 1; j >= 0 ; j--)
3606 {
3607 if (CONST_WIDE_INT_ELT (x, j) < CONST_WIDE_INT_ELT (y, j))
3608 return -1;
3609 if (CONST_WIDE_INT_ELT (x, j) > CONST_WIDE_INT_ELT (y, j))
3610 return 1;
3611 }
3612 }
3613
3614 return 0;
3615 }
3616
3617 /* Check the order of entries in one-part variables. */
3618
3619 int
3620 canonicalize_loc_order_check (variable **slot,
3621 dataflow_set *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3622 {
3623 variable *var = *slot;
3624 location_chain *node, *next;
3625
3626 #ifdef ENABLE_RTL_CHECKING
3627 int i;
3628 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
3629 gcc_assert (var->var_part[0].cur_loc == NULL);
3630 gcc_assert (!var->in_changed_variables);
3631 #endif
3632
3633 if (!var->onepart)
3634 return 1;
3635
3636 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3637 node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain;
3638 gcc_assert (node);
3639
3640 while ((next = node->next))
3641 {
3642 gcc_assert (loc_cmp (node->loc, next->loc) < 0);
3643 node = next;
3644 }
3645
3646 return 1;
3647 }
3648
3649 /* Mark with VALUE_RECURSED_INTO values that have neighbors that are
3650 more likely to be chosen as canonical for an equivalence set.
3651 Ensure less likely values can reach more likely neighbors, making
3652 the connections bidirectional. */
3653
3654 int
3655 canonicalize_values_mark (variable **slot, dataflow_set *set)
3656 {
3657 variable *var = *slot;
3658 decl_or_value dv = var->dv;
3659 rtx val;
3660 location_chain *node;
3661
3662 if (!dv_is_value_p (dv))
3663 return 1;
3664
3665 gcc_checking_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3666
3667 val = dv_as_value (dv);
3668
3669 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3670 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3671 {
3672 if (canon_value_cmp (node->loc, val))
3673 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = true;
3674 else
3675 {
3676 decl_or_value odv = dv_from_value (node->loc);
3677 variable **oslot;
3678 oslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, odv);
3679
3680 set_slot_part (set, val, oslot, odv, 0,
3681 node->init, NULL_RTX);
3682
3683 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = true;
3684 }
3685 }
3686
3687 return 1;
3688 }
3689
3690 /* Remove redundant entries from equivalence lists in onepart
3691 variables, canonicalizing equivalence sets into star shapes. */
3692
3693 int
3694 canonicalize_values_star (variable **slot, dataflow_set *set)
3695 {
3696 variable *var = *slot;
3697 decl_or_value dv = var->dv;
3698 location_chain *node;
3699 decl_or_value cdv;
3700 rtx val, cval;
3701 variable **cslot;
3702 bool has_value;
3703 bool has_marks;
3704
3705 if (!var->onepart)
3706 return 1;
3707
3708 gcc_checking_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3709
3710 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
3711 {
3712 cval = dv_as_value (dv);
3713 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval))
3714 return 1;
3715 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval) = false;
3716 }
3717 else
3718 cval = NULL_RTX;
3719
3720 restart:
3721 val = cval;
3722 has_value = false;
3723 has_marks = false;
3724
3725 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3726
3727 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3728 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3729 {
3730 has_value = true;
3731 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc))
3732 has_marks = true;
3733 if (canon_value_cmp (node->loc, cval))
3734 cval = node->loc;
3735 }
3736
3737 if (!has_value)
3738 return 1;
3739
3740 if (cval == val)
3741 {
3742 if (!has_marks || dv_is_decl_p (dv))
3743 return 1;
3744
3745 /* Keep it marked so that we revisit it, either after visiting a
3746 child node, or after visiting a new parent that might be
3747 found out. */
3748 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = true;
3749
3750 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3751 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE
3752 && VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc))
3753 {
3754 cval = node->loc;
3755 restart_with_cval:
3756 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval) = false;
3757 dv = dv_from_value (cval);
3758 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, dv);
3759 if (!slot)
3760 {
3761 gcc_assert (dv_is_decl_p (var->dv));
3762 /* The canonical value was reset and dropped.
3763 Remove it. */
3764 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL, var->dv, 0, NULL);
3765 return 1;
3766 }
3767 var = *slot;
3768 gcc_assert (dv_is_value_p (var->dv));
3769 if (var->n_var_parts == 0)
3770 return 1;
3771 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3772 goto restart;
3773 }
3774
3775 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = false;
3776
3777 return 1;
3778 }
3779
3780 /* Push values to the canonical one. */
3781 cdv = dv_from_value (cval);
3782 cslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, cdv);
3783
3784 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
3785 if (node->loc != cval)
3786 {
3787 cslot = set_slot_part (set, node->loc, cslot, cdv, 0,
3788 node->init, NULL_RTX);
3789 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
3790 {
3791 decl_or_value ndv = dv_from_value (node->loc);
3792
3793 set_variable_part (set, cval, ndv, 0, node->init, NULL_RTX,
3794 NO_INSERT);
3795
3796 if (canon_value_cmp (node->loc, val))
3797 {
3798 /* If it could have been a local minimum, it's not any more,
3799 since it's now neighbor to cval, so it may have to push
3800 to it. Conversely, if it wouldn't have prevailed over
3801 val, then whatever mark it has is fine: if it was to
3802 push, it will now push to a more canonical node, but if
3803 it wasn't, then it has already pushed any values it might
3804 have to. */
3805 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = true;
3806 /* Make sure we visit node->loc by ensuring we cval is
3807 visited too. */
3808 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval) = true;
3809 }
3810 else if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc))
3811 /* If we have no need to "recurse" into this node, it's
3812 already "canonicalized", so drop the link to the old
3813 parent. */
3814 clobber_variable_part (set, cval, ndv, 0, NULL);
3815 }
3816 else if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == REG)
3817 {
3818 attrs *list = set->regs[REGNO (node->loc)], **listp;
3819
3820 /* Change an existing attribute referring to dv so that it
3821 refers to cdv, removing any duplicate this might
3822 introduce, and checking that no previous duplicates
3823 existed, all in a single pass. */
3824
3825 while (list)
3826 {
3827 if (list->offset == 0
3828 && (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv)
3829 || dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (cdv)))
3830 break;
3831
3832 list = list->next;
3833 }
3834
3835 gcc_assert (list);
3836 if (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv))
3837 {
3838 list->dv = cdv;
3839 for (listp = &list->next; (list = *listp); listp = &list->next)
3840 {
3841 if (list->offset)
3842 continue;
3843
3844 if (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (cdv))
3845 {
3846 *listp = list->next;
3847 delete list;
3848 list = *listp;
3849 break;
3850 }
3851
3852 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) != dv_as_opaque (dv));
3853 }
3854 }
3855 else if (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (cdv))
3856 {
3857 for (listp = &list->next; (list = *listp); listp = &list->next)
3858 {
3859 if (list->offset)
3860 continue;
3861
3862 if (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv))
3863 {
3864 *listp = list->next;
3865 delete list;
3866 list = *listp;
3867 break;
3868 }
3869
3870 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) != dv_as_opaque (cdv));
3871 }
3872 }
3873 else
3874 gcc_unreachable ();
3875
3876 if (flag_checking)
3877 while (list)
3878 {
3879 if (list->offset == 0
3880 && (dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv)
3881 || dv_as_opaque (list->dv) == dv_as_opaque (cdv)))
3882 gcc_unreachable ();
3883
3884 list = list->next;
3885 }
3886 }
3887 }
3888
3889 if (val)
3890 set_slot_part (set, val, cslot, cdv, 0,
3891 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX);
3892
3893 slot = clobber_slot_part (set, cval, slot, 0, NULL);
3894
3895 /* Variable may have been unshared. */
3896 var = *slot;
3897 gcc_checking_assert (var->n_var_parts && var->var_part[0].loc_chain->loc == cval
3898 && var->var_part[0].loc_chain->next == NULL);
3899
3900 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval))
3901 goto restart_with_cval;
3902
3903 return 1;
3904 }
3905
3906 /* Bind one-part variables to the canonical value in an equivalence
3907 set. Not doing this causes dataflow convergence failure in rare
3908 circumstances, see PR42873. Unfortunately we can't do this
3909 efficiently as part of canonicalize_values_star, since we may not
3910 have determined or even seen the canonical value of a set when we
3911 get to a variable that references another member of the set. */
3912
3913 int
3914 canonicalize_vars_star (variable **slot, dataflow_set *set)
3915 {
3916 variable *var = *slot;
3917 decl_or_value dv = var->dv;
3918 location_chain *node;
3919 rtx cval;
3920 decl_or_value cdv;
3921 variable **cslot;
3922 variable *cvar;
3923 location_chain *cnode;
3924
3925 if (!var->onepart || var->onepart == ONEPART_VALUE)
3926 return 1;
3927
3928 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
3929
3930 node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain;
3931
3932 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) != VALUE)
3933 return 1;
3934
3935 gcc_assert (!node->next);
3936 cval = node->loc;
3937
3938 /* Push values to the canonical one. */
3939 cdv = dv_from_value (cval);
3940 cslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, cdv);
3941 if (!cslot)
3942 return 1;
3943 cvar = *cslot;
3944 gcc_assert (cvar->n_var_parts == 1);
3945
3946 cnode = cvar->var_part[0].loc_chain;
3947
3948 /* CVAL is canonical if its value list contains non-VALUEs or VALUEs
3949 that are not “more canonical” than it. */
3950 if (GET_CODE (cnode->loc) != VALUE
3951 || !canon_value_cmp (cnode->loc, cval))
3952 return 1;
3953
3954 /* CVAL was found to be non-canonical. Change the variable to point
3955 to the canonical VALUE. */
3956 gcc_assert (!cnode->next);
3957 cval = cnode->loc;
3958
3959 slot = set_slot_part (set, cval, slot, dv, 0,
3960 node->init, node->set_src);
3961 clobber_slot_part (set, cval, slot, 0, node->set_src);
3962
3963 return 1;
3964 }
3965
3966 /* Combine variable or value in *S1SLOT (in DSM->cur) with the
3967 corresponding entry in DSM->src. Multi-part variables are combined
3968 with variable_union, whereas onepart dvs are combined with
3969 intersection. */
3970
3971 static int
3972 variable_merge_over_cur (variable *s1var, struct dfset_merge *dsm)
3973 {
3974 dataflow_set *dst = dsm->dst;
3975 variable **dstslot;
3976 variable *s2var, *dvar = NULL;
3977 decl_or_value dv = s1var->dv;
3978 onepart_enum onepart = s1var->onepart;
3979 rtx val;
3980 hashval_t dvhash;
3981 location_chain *node, **nodep;
3982
3983 /* If the incoming onepart variable has an empty location list, then
3984 the intersection will be just as empty. For other variables,
3985 it's always union. */
3986 gcc_checking_assert (s1var->n_var_parts
3987 && s1var->var_part[0].loc_chain);
3988
3989 if (!onepart)
3990 return variable_union (s1var, dst);
3991
3992 gcc_checking_assert (s1var->n_var_parts == 1);
3993
3994 dvhash = dv_htab_hash (dv);
3995 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
3996 val = dv_as_value (dv);
3997 else
3998 val = NULL;
3999
4000 s2var = shared_hash_find_1 (dsm->src->vars, dv, dvhash);
4001 if (!s2var)
4002 {
4003 dst_can_be_shared = false;
4004 return 1;
4005 }
4006
4007 dsm->src_onepart_cnt--;
4008 gcc_assert (s2var->var_part[0].loc_chain
4009 && s2var->onepart == onepart
4010 && s2var->n_var_parts == 1);
4011
4012 dstslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst->vars, dv, dvhash);
4013 if (dstslot)
4014 {
4015 dvar = *dstslot;
4016 gcc_assert (dvar->refcount == 1
4017 && dvar->onepart == onepart
4018 && dvar->n_var_parts == 1);
4019 nodep = &dvar->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4020 }
4021 else
4022 {
4023 nodep = &node;
4024 node = NULL;
4025 }
4026
4027 if (!dstslot && !onepart_variable_different_p (s1var, s2var))
4028 {
4029 dstslot = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (&dst->vars, dv,
4030 dvhash, INSERT);
4031 *dstslot = dvar = s2var;
4032 dvar->refcount++;
4033 }
4034 else
4035 {
4036 dst_can_be_shared = false;
4037
4038 intersect_loc_chains (val, nodep, dsm,
4039 s1var->var_part[0].loc_chain, s2var);
4040
4041 if (!dstslot)
4042 {
4043 if (node)
4044 {
4045 dvar = onepart_pool_allocate (onepart);
4046 dvar->dv = dv;
4047 dvar->refcount = 1;
4048 dvar->n_var_parts = 1;
4049 dvar->onepart = onepart;
4050 dvar->in_changed_variables = false;
4051 dvar->var_part[0].loc_chain = node;
4052 dvar->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
4053 if (onepart)
4054 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar) = NULL;
4055 else
4056 VAR_PART_OFFSET (dvar, 0) = 0;
4057
4058 dstslot
4059 = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare_1 (&dst->vars, dv, dvhash,
4060 INSERT);
4061 gcc_assert (!*dstslot);
4062 *dstslot = dvar;
4063 }
4064 else
4065 return 1;
4066 }
4067 }
4068
4069 nodep = &dvar->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4070 while ((node = *nodep))
4071 {
4072 location_chain **nextp = &node->next;
4073
4074 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == REG)
4075 {
4076 attrs *list;
4077
4078 for (list = dst->regs[REGNO (node->loc)]; list; list = list->next)
4079 if (GET_MODE (node->loc) == GET_MODE (list->loc)
4080 && dv_is_value_p (list->dv))
4081 break;
4082
4083 if (!list)
4084 attrs_list_insert (&dst->regs[REGNO (node->loc)],
4085 dv, 0, node->loc);
4086 /* If this value became canonical for another value that had
4087 this register, we want to leave it alone. */
4088 else if (dv_as_value (list->dv) != val)
4089 {
4090 dstslot = set_slot_part (dst, dv_as_value (list->dv),
4091 dstslot, dv, 0,
4092 node->init, NULL_RTX);
4093 dstslot = delete_slot_part (dst, node->loc, dstslot, 0);
4094
4095 /* Since nextp points into the removed node, we can't
4096 use it. The pointer to the next node moved to nodep.
4097 However, if the variable we're walking is unshared
4098 during our walk, we'll keep walking the location list
4099 of the previously-shared variable, in which case the
4100 node won't have been removed, and we'll want to skip
4101 it. That's why we test *nodep here. */
4102 if (*nodep != node)
4103 nextp = nodep;
4104 }
4105 }
4106 else
4107 /* Canonicalization puts registers first, so we don't have to
4108 walk it all. */
4109 break;
4110 nodep = nextp;
4111 }
4112
4113 if (dvar != *dstslot)
4114 dvar = *dstslot;
4115 nodep = &dvar->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4116
4117 if (val)
4118 {
4119 /* Mark all referenced nodes for canonicalization, and make sure
4120 we have mutual equivalence links. */
4121 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = true;
4122 for (node = *nodep; node; node = node->next)
4123 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
4124 {
4125 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = true;
4126 set_variable_part (dst, val, dv_from_value (node->loc), 0,
4127 node->init, NULL, INSERT);
4128 }
4129
4130 dstslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst->vars, dv, dvhash);
4131 gcc_assert (*dstslot == dvar);
4132 canonicalize_values_star (dstslot, dst);
4133 gcc_checking_assert (dstslot
4134 == shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst->vars,
4135 dv, dvhash));
4136 dvar = *dstslot;
4137 }
4138 else
4139 {
4140 bool has_value = false, has_other = false;
4141
4142 /* If we have one value and anything else, we're going to
4143 canonicalize this, so make sure all values have an entry in
4144 the table and are marked for canonicalization. */
4145 for (node = *nodep; node; node = node->next)
4146 {
4147 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
4148 {
4149 /* If this was marked during register canonicalization,
4150 we know we have to canonicalize values. */
4151 if (has_value)
4152 has_other = true;
4153 has_value = true;
4154 if (has_other)
4155 break;
4156 }
4157 else
4158 {
4159 has_other = true;
4160 if (has_value)
4161 break;
4162 }
4163 }
4164
4165 if (has_value && has_other)
4166 {
4167 for (node = *nodep; node; node = node->next)
4168 {
4169 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
4170 {
4171 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_value (node->loc);
4172 variable **slot = NULL;
4173
4174 if (shared_hash_shared (dst->vars))
4175 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (dst->vars, dv);
4176 if (!slot)
4177 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&dst->vars, dv,
4178 INSERT);
4179 if (!*slot)
4180 {
4181 variable *var = onepart_pool_allocate (ONEPART_VALUE);
4182 var->dv = dv;
4183 var->refcount = 1;
4184 var->n_var_parts = 1;
4185 var->onepart = ONEPART_VALUE;
4186 var->in_changed_variables = false;
4187 var->var_part[0].loc_chain = NULL;
4188 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
4189 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = NULL;
4190 *slot = var;
4191 }
4192
4193 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = true;
4194 }
4195 }
4196
4197 dstslot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst->vars, dv, dvhash);
4198 gcc_assert (*dstslot == dvar);
4199 canonicalize_values_star (dstslot, dst);
4200 gcc_checking_assert (dstslot
4201 == shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert_1 (dst->vars,
4202 dv, dvhash));
4203 dvar = *dstslot;
4204 }
4205 }
4206
4207 if (!onepart_variable_different_p (dvar, s2var))
4208 {
4209 variable_htab_free (dvar);
4210 *dstslot = dvar = s2var;
4211 dvar->refcount++;
4212 }
4213 else if (s2var != s1var && !onepart_variable_different_p (dvar, s1var))
4214 {
4215 variable_htab_free (dvar);
4216 *dstslot = dvar = s1var;
4217 dvar->refcount++;
4218 dst_can_be_shared = false;
4219 }
4220 else
4221 dst_can_be_shared = false;
4222
4223 return 1;
4224 }
4225
4226 /* Copy s2slot (in DSM->src) to DSM->dst if the variable is a
4227 multi-part variable. Unions of multi-part variables and
4228 intersections of one-part ones will be handled in
4229 variable_merge_over_cur(). */
4230
4231 static int
4232 variable_merge_over_src (variable *s2var, struct dfset_merge *dsm)
4233 {
4234 dataflow_set *dst = dsm->dst;
4235 decl_or_value dv = s2var->dv;
4236
4237 if (!s2var->onepart)
4238 {
4239 variable **dstp = shared_hash_find_slot (dst->vars, dv);
4240 *dstp = s2var;
4241 s2var->refcount++;
4242 return 1;
4243 }
4244
4245 dsm->src_onepart_cnt++;
4246 return 1;
4247 }
4248
4249 /* Combine dataflow set information from SRC2 into DST, using PDST
4250 to carry over information across passes. */
4251
4252 static void
4253 dataflow_set_merge (dataflow_set *dst, dataflow_set *src2)
4254 {
4255 dataflow_set cur = *dst;
4256 dataflow_set *src1 = &cur;
4257 struct dfset_merge dsm;
4258 int i;
4259 size_t src1_elems, src2_elems;
4260 variable_iterator_type hi;
4261 variable *var;
4262
4263 src1_elems = shared_hash_htab (src1->vars)->elements ();
4264 src2_elems = shared_hash_htab (src2->vars)->elements ();
4265 dataflow_set_init (dst);
4266 dst->stack_adjust = cur.stack_adjust;
4267 shared_hash_destroy (dst->vars);
4268 dst->vars = new shared_hash;
4269 dst->vars->refcount = 1;
4270 dst->vars->htab = new variable_table_type (MAX (src1_elems, src2_elems));
4271
4272 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4273 attrs_list_mpdv_union (&dst->regs[i], src1->regs[i], src2->regs[i]);
4274
4275 dsm.dst = dst;
4276 dsm.src = src2;
4277 dsm.cur = src1;
4278 dsm.src_onepart_cnt = 0;
4279
4280 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*shared_hash_htab (dsm.src->vars),
4281 var, variable, hi)
4282 variable_merge_over_src (var, &dsm);
4283 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*shared_hash_htab (dsm.cur->vars),
4284 var, variable, hi)
4285 variable_merge_over_cur (var, &dsm);
4286
4287 if (dsm.src_onepart_cnt)
4288 dst_can_be_shared = false;
4289
4290 dataflow_set_destroy (src1);
4291 }
4292
4293 /* Mark register equivalences. */
4294
4295 static void
4296 dataflow_set_equiv_regs (dataflow_set *set)
4297 {
4298 int i;
4299 attrs *list, **listp;
4300
4301 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
4302 {
4303 rtx canon[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
4304
4305 /* If the list is empty or one entry, no need to canonicalize
4306 anything. */
4307 if (set->regs[i] == NULL || set->regs[i]->next == NULL)
4308 continue;
4309
4310 memset (canon, 0, sizeof (canon));
4311
4312 for (list = set->regs[i]; list; list = list->next)
4313 if (list->offset == 0 && dv_is_value_p (list->dv))
4314 {
4315 rtx val = dv_as_value (list->dv);
4316 rtx *cvalp = &canon[(int)GET_MODE (val)];
4317 rtx cval = *cvalp;
4318
4319 if (canon_value_cmp (val, cval))
4320 *cvalp = val;
4321 }
4322
4323 for (list = set->regs[i]; list; list = list->next)
4324 if (list->offset == 0 && dv_onepart_p (list->dv))
4325 {
4326 rtx cval = canon[(int)GET_MODE (list->loc)];
4327
4328 if (!cval)
4329 continue;
4330
4331 if (dv_is_value_p (list->dv))
4332 {
4333 rtx val = dv_as_value (list->dv);
4334
4335 if (val == cval)
4336 continue;
4337
4338 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = true;
4339 set_variable_part (set, val, dv_from_value (cval), 0,
4340 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
4341 NULL, NO_INSERT);
4342 }
4343
4344 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (cval) = true;
4345 set_variable_part (set, cval, list->dv, 0,
4346 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, NO_INSERT);
4347 }
4348
4349 for (listp = &set->regs[i]; (list = *listp);
4350 listp = list ? &list->next : listp)
4351 if (list->offset == 0 && dv_onepart_p (list->dv))
4352 {
4353 rtx cval = canon[(int)GET_MODE (list->loc)];
4354 variable **slot;
4355
4356 if (!cval)
4357 continue;
4358
4359 if (dv_is_value_p (list->dv))
4360 {
4361 rtx val = dv_as_value (list->dv);
4362 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val))
4363 continue;
4364 }
4365
4366 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, list->dv);
4367 canonicalize_values_star (slot, set);
4368 if (*listp != list)
4369 list = NULL;
4370 }
4371 }
4372 }
4373
4374 /* Remove any redundant values in the location list of VAR, which must
4375 be unshared and 1-part. */
4376
4377 static void
4378 remove_duplicate_values (variable *var)
4379 {
4380 location_chain *node, **nodep;
4381
4382 gcc_assert (var->onepart);
4383 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
4384 gcc_assert (var->refcount == 1);
4385
4386 for (nodep = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; (node = *nodep); )
4387 {
4388 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
4389 {
4390 if (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc))
4391 {
4392 /* Remove duplicate value node. */
4393 *nodep = node->next;
4394 delete node;
4395 continue;
4396 }
4397 else
4398 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = true;
4399 }
4400 nodep = &node->next;
4401 }
4402
4403 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
4404 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
4405 {
4406 gcc_assert (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc));
4407 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc) = false;
4408 }
4409 }
4410
4411
4412 /* Hash table iteration argument passed to variable_post_merge. */
4413 struct dfset_post_merge
4414 {
4415 /* The new input set for the current block. */
4416 dataflow_set *set;
4417 /* Pointer to the permanent input set for the current block, or
4418 NULL. */
4419 dataflow_set **permp;
4420 };
4421
4422 /* Create values for incoming expressions associated with one-part
4423 variables that don't have value numbers for them. */
4424
4425 int
4426 variable_post_merge_new_vals (variable **slot, dfset_post_merge *dfpm)
4427 {
4428 dataflow_set *set = dfpm->set;
4429 variable *var = *slot;
4430 location_chain *node;
4431
4432 if (!var->onepart || !var->n_var_parts)
4433 return 1;
4434
4435 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
4436
4437 if (dv_is_decl_p (var->dv))
4438 {
4439 bool check_dupes = false;
4440
4441 restart:
4442 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
4443 {
4444 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
4445 gcc_assert (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc));
4446 else if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == REG)
4447 {
4448 attrs *att, **attp, **curp = NULL;
4449
4450 if (var->refcount != 1)
4451 {
4452 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var,
4453 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
4454 var = *slot;
4455 goto restart;
4456 }
4457
4458 for (attp = &set->regs[REGNO (node->loc)]; (att = *attp);
4459 attp = &att->next)
4460 if (att->offset == 0
4461 && GET_MODE (att->loc) == GET_MODE (node->loc))
4462 {
4463 if (dv_is_value_p (att->dv))
4464 {
4465 rtx cval = dv_as_value (att->dv);
4466 node->loc = cval;
4467 check_dupes = true;
4468 break;
4469 }
4470 else if (dv_as_opaque (att->dv) == dv_as_opaque (var->dv))
4471 curp = attp;
4472 }
4473
4474 if (!curp)
4475 {
4476 curp = attp;
4477 while (*curp)
4478 if ((*curp)->offset == 0
4479 && GET_MODE ((*curp)->loc) == GET_MODE (node->loc)
4480 && dv_as_opaque ((*curp)->dv) == dv_as_opaque (var->dv))
4481 break;
4482 else
4483 curp = &(*curp)->next;
4484 gcc_assert (*curp);
4485 }
4486
4487 if (!att)
4488 {
4489 decl_or_value cdv;
4490 rtx cval;
4491
4492 if (!*dfpm->permp)
4493 {
4494 *dfpm->permp = XNEW (dataflow_set);
4495 dataflow_set_init (*dfpm->permp);
4496 }
4497
4498 for (att = (*dfpm->permp)->regs[REGNO (node->loc)];
4499 att; att = att->next)
4500 if (GET_MODE (att->loc) == GET_MODE (node->loc))
4501 {
4502 gcc_assert (att->offset == 0
4503 && dv_is_value_p (att->dv));
4504 val_reset (set, att->dv);
4505 break;
4506 }
4507
4508 if (att)
4509 {
4510 cdv = att->dv;
4511 cval = dv_as_value (cdv);
4512 }
4513 else
4514 {
4515 /* Create a unique value to hold this register,
4516 that ought to be found and reused in
4517 subsequent rounds. */
4518 cselib_val *v;
4519 gcc_assert (!cselib_lookup (node->loc,
4520 GET_MODE (node->loc), 0,
4521 VOIDmode));
4522 v = cselib_lookup (node->loc, GET_MODE (node->loc), 1,
4523 VOIDmode);
4524 cselib_preserve_value (v);
4525 cselib_invalidate_rtx (node->loc);
4526 cval = v->val_rtx;
4527 cdv = dv_from_value (cval);
4528 if (dump_file)
4529 fprintf (dump_file,
4530 "Created new value %u:%u for reg %i\n",
4531 v->uid, v->hash, REGNO (node->loc));
4532 }
4533
4534 var_reg_decl_set (*dfpm->permp, node->loc,
4535 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
4536 cdv, 0, NULL, INSERT);
4537
4538 node->loc = cval;
4539 check_dupes = true;
4540 }
4541
4542 /* Remove attribute referring to the decl, which now
4543 uses the value for the register, already existing or
4544 to be added when we bring perm in. */
4545 att = *curp;
4546 *curp = att->next;
4547 delete att;
4548 }
4549 }
4550
4551 if (check_dupes)
4552 remove_duplicate_values (var);
4553 }
4554
4555 return 1;
4556 }
4557
4558 /* Reset values in the permanent set that are not associated with the
4559 chosen expression. */
4560
4561 int
4562 variable_post_merge_perm_vals (variable **pslot, dfset_post_merge *dfpm)
4563 {
4564 dataflow_set *set = dfpm->set;
4565 variable *pvar = *pslot, *var;
4566 location_chain *pnode;
4567 decl_or_value dv;
4568 attrs *att;
4569
4570 gcc_assert (dv_is_value_p (pvar->dv)
4571 && pvar->n_var_parts == 1);
4572 pnode = pvar->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4573 gcc_assert (pnode
4574 && !pnode->next
4575 && REG_P (pnode->loc));
4576
4577 dv = pvar->dv;
4578
4579 var = shared_hash_find (set->vars, dv);
4580 if (var)
4581 {
4582 /* Although variable_post_merge_new_vals may have made decls
4583 non-star-canonical, values that pre-existed in canonical form
4584 remain canonical, and newly-created values reference a single
4585 REG, so they are canonical as well. Since VAR has the
4586 location list for a VALUE, using find_loc_in_1pdv for it is
4587 fine, since VALUEs don't map back to DECLs. */
4588 if (find_loc_in_1pdv (pnode->loc, var, shared_hash_htab (set->vars)))
4589 return 1;
4590 val_reset (set, dv);
4591 }
4592
4593 for (att = set->regs[REGNO (pnode->loc)]; att; att = att->next)
4594 if (att->offset == 0
4595 && GET_MODE (att->loc) == GET_MODE (pnode->loc)
4596 && dv_is_value_p (att->dv))
4597 break;
4598
4599 /* If there is a value associated with this register already, create
4600 an equivalence. */
4601 if (att && dv_as_value (att->dv) != dv_as_value (dv))
4602 {
4603 rtx cval = dv_as_value (att->dv);
4604 set_variable_part (set, cval, dv, 0, pnode->init, NULL, INSERT);
4605 set_variable_part (set, dv_as_value (dv), att->dv, 0, pnode->init,
4606 NULL, INSERT);
4607 }
4608 else if (!att)
4609 {
4610 attrs_list_insert (&set->regs[REGNO (pnode->loc)],
4611 dv, 0, pnode->loc);
4612 variable_union (pvar, set);
4613 }
4614
4615 return 1;
4616 }
4617
4618 /* Just checking stuff and registering register attributes for
4619 now. */
4620
4621 static void
4622 dataflow_post_merge_adjust (dataflow_set *set, dataflow_set **permp)
4623 {
4624 struct dfset_post_merge dfpm;
4625
4626 dfpm.set = set;
4627 dfpm.permp = permp;
4628
4629 shared_hash_htab (set->vars)
4630 ->traverse <dfset_post_merge*, variable_post_merge_new_vals> (&dfpm);
4631 if (*permp)
4632 shared_hash_htab ((*permp)->vars)
4633 ->traverse <dfset_post_merge*, variable_post_merge_perm_vals> (&dfpm);
4634 shared_hash_htab (set->vars)
4635 ->traverse <dataflow_set *, canonicalize_values_star> (set);
4636 shared_hash_htab (set->vars)
4637 ->traverse <dataflow_set *, canonicalize_vars_star> (set);
4638 }
4639
4640 /* Return a node whose loc is a MEM that refers to EXPR in the
4641 location list of a one-part variable or value VAR, or in that of
4642 any values recursively mentioned in the location lists. */
4643
4644 static location_chain *
4645 find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (tree expr, rtx val, variable_table_type *vars)
4646 {
4647 location_chain *node;
4648 decl_or_value dv;
4649 variable *var;
4650 location_chain *where = NULL;
4651
4652 if (!val)
4653 return NULL;
4654
4655 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (val) == VALUE
4656 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val));
4657
4658 dv = dv_from_value (val);
4659 var = vars->find_with_hash (dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
4660
4661 if (!var)
4662 return NULL;
4663
4664 gcc_assert (var->onepart);
4665
4666 if (!var->n_var_parts)
4667 return NULL;
4668
4669 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = true;
4670
4671 for (node = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
4672 if (MEM_P (node->loc)
4673 && MEM_EXPR (node->loc) == expr
4674 && int_mem_offset (node->loc) == 0)
4675 {
4676 where = node;
4677 break;
4678 }
4679 else if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE
4680 && !VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (node->loc)
4681 && (where = find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (expr, node->loc, vars)))
4682 break;
4683
4684 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (val) = false;
4685
4686 return where;
4687 }
4688
4689 /* Return TRUE if the value of MEM may vary across a call. */
4690
4691 static bool
4692 mem_dies_at_call (rtx mem)
4693 {
4694 tree expr = MEM_EXPR (mem);
4695 tree decl;
4696
4697 if (!expr)
4698 return true;
4699
4700 decl = get_base_address (expr);
4701
4702 if (!decl)
4703 return true;
4704
4705 if (!DECL_P (decl))
4706 return true;
4707
4708 return (may_be_aliased (decl)
4709 || (!TREE_READONLY (decl) && is_global_var (decl)));
4710 }
4711
4712 /* Remove all MEMs from the location list of a hash table entry for a
4713 one-part variable, except those whose MEM attributes map back to
4714 the variable itself, directly or within a VALUE. */
4715
4716 int
4717 dataflow_set_preserve_mem_locs (variable **slot, dataflow_set *set)
4718 {
4719 variable *var = *slot;
4720
4721 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_VDECL || var->onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR)
4722 {
4723 tree decl = dv_as_decl (var->dv);
4724 location_chain *loc, **locp;
4725 bool changed = false;
4726
4727 if (!var->n_var_parts)
4728 return 1;
4729
4730 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
4731
4732 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
4733 {
4734 for (loc = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; loc; loc = loc->next)
4735 {
4736 /* We want to remove dying MEMs that don't refer to DECL. */
4737 if (GET_CODE (loc->loc) == MEM
4738 && (MEM_EXPR (loc->loc) != decl
4739 || int_mem_offset (loc->loc) != 0)
4740 && mem_dies_at_call (loc->loc))
4741 break;
4742 /* We want to move here MEMs that do refer to DECL. */
4743 else if (GET_CODE (loc->loc) == VALUE
4744 && find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (decl, loc->loc,
4745 shared_hash_htab (set->vars)))
4746 break;
4747 }
4748
4749 if (!loc)
4750 return 1;
4751
4752 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
4753 var = *slot;
4754 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
4755 }
4756
4757 for (locp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain, loc = *locp;
4758 loc; loc = *locp)
4759 {
4760 rtx old_loc = loc->loc;
4761 if (GET_CODE (old_loc) == VALUE)
4762 {
4763 location_chain *mem_node
4764 = find_mem_expr_in_1pdv (decl, loc->loc,
4765 shared_hash_htab (set->vars));
4766
4767 /* ??? This picks up only one out of multiple MEMs that
4768 refer to the same variable. Do we ever need to be
4769 concerned about dealing with more than one, or, given
4770 that they should all map to the same variable
4771 location, their addresses will have been merged and
4772 they will be regarded as equivalent? */
4773 if (mem_node)
4774 {
4775 loc->loc = mem_node->loc;
4776 loc->set_src = mem_node->set_src;
4777 loc->init = MIN (loc->init, mem_node->init);
4778 }
4779 }
4780
4781 if (GET_CODE (loc->loc) != MEM
4782 || (MEM_EXPR (loc->loc) == decl
4783 && int_mem_offset (loc->loc) == 0)
4784 || !mem_dies_at_call (loc->loc))
4785 {
4786 if (old_loc != loc->loc && emit_notes)
4787 {
4788 if (old_loc == var->var_part[0].cur_loc)
4789 {
4790 changed = true;
4791 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
4792 }
4793 }
4794 locp = &loc->next;
4795 continue;
4796 }
4797
4798 if (emit_notes)
4799 {
4800 if (old_loc == var->var_part[0].cur_loc)
4801 {
4802 changed = true;
4803 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
4804 }
4805 }
4806 *locp = loc->next;
4807 delete loc;
4808 }
4809
4810 if (!var->var_part[0].loc_chain)
4811 {
4812 var->n_var_parts--;
4813 changed = true;
4814 }
4815 if (changed)
4816 variable_was_changed (var, set);
4817 }
4818
4819 return 1;
4820 }
4821
4822 /* Remove all MEMs from the location list of a hash table entry for a
4823 onepart variable. */
4824
4825 int
4826 dataflow_set_remove_mem_locs (variable **slot, dataflow_set *set)
4827 {
4828 variable *var = *slot;
4829
4830 if (var->onepart != NOT_ONEPART)
4831 {
4832 location_chain *loc, **locp;
4833 bool changed = false;
4834 rtx cur_loc;
4835
4836 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
4837
4838 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
4839 {
4840 for (loc = var->var_part[0].loc_chain; loc; loc = loc->next)
4841 if (GET_CODE (loc->loc) == MEM
4842 && mem_dies_at_call (loc->loc))
4843 break;
4844
4845 if (!loc)
4846 return 1;
4847
4848 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
4849 var = *slot;
4850 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
4851 }
4852
4853 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
4854 cur_loc = VAR_LOC_FROM (var);
4855 else
4856 cur_loc = var->var_part[0].cur_loc;
4857
4858 for (locp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain, loc = *locp;
4859 loc; loc = *locp)
4860 {
4861 if (GET_CODE (loc->loc) != MEM
4862 || !mem_dies_at_call (loc->loc))
4863 {
4864 locp = &loc->next;
4865 continue;
4866 }
4867
4868 *locp = loc->next;
4869 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
4870 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
4871 of changed variables. */
4872 if (cur_loc == loc->loc)
4873 {
4874 changed = true;
4875 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
4876 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
4877 VAR_LOC_FROM (var) = NULL;
4878 }
4879 delete loc;
4880 }
4881
4882 if (!var->var_part[0].loc_chain)
4883 {
4884 var->n_var_parts--;
4885 changed = true;
4886 }
4887 if (changed)
4888 variable_was_changed (var, set);
4889 }
4890
4891 return 1;
4892 }
4893
4894 /* Remove all variable-location information about call-clobbered
4895 registers, as well as associations between MEMs and VALUEs. */
4896
4897 static void
4898 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (dataflow_set *set, rtx_insn *call_insn)
4899 {
4900 unsigned int r;
4901 hard_reg_set_iterator hrsi;
4902 HARD_REG_SET invalidated_regs;
4903
4904 get_call_reg_set_usage (call_insn, &invalidated_regs,
4905 regs_invalidated_by_call);
4906
4907 EXECUTE_IF_SET_IN_HARD_REG_SET (invalidated_regs, 0, r, hrsi)
4908 var_regno_delete (set, r);
4909
4910 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
4911 {
4912 set->traversed_vars = set->vars;
4913 shared_hash_htab (set->vars)
4914 ->traverse <dataflow_set *, dataflow_set_preserve_mem_locs> (set);
4915 set->traversed_vars = set->vars;
4916 shared_hash_htab (set->vars)
4917 ->traverse <dataflow_set *, dataflow_set_remove_mem_locs> (set);
4918 set->traversed_vars = NULL;
4919 }
4920 }
4921
4922 static bool
4923 variable_part_different_p (variable_part *vp1, variable_part *vp2)
4924 {
4925 location_chain *lc1, *lc2;
4926
4927 for (lc1 = vp1->loc_chain; lc1; lc1 = lc1->next)
4928 {
4929 for (lc2 = vp2->loc_chain; lc2; lc2 = lc2->next)
4930 {
4931 if (REG_P (lc1->loc) && REG_P (lc2->loc))
4932 {
4933 if (REGNO (lc1->loc) == REGNO (lc2->loc))
4934 break;
4935 }
4936 if (rtx_equal_p (lc1->loc, lc2->loc))
4937 break;
4938 }
4939 if (!lc2)
4940 return true;
4941 }
4942 return false;
4943 }
4944
4945 /* Return true if one-part variables VAR1 and VAR2 are different.
4946 They must be in canonical order. */
4947
4948 static bool
4949 onepart_variable_different_p (variable *var1, variable *var2)
4950 {
4951 location_chain *lc1, *lc2;
4952
4953 if (var1 == var2)
4954 return false;
4955
4956 gcc_assert (var1->n_var_parts == 1
4957 && var2->n_var_parts == 1);
4958
4959 lc1 = var1->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4960 lc2 = var2->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4961
4962 gcc_assert (lc1 && lc2);
4963
4964 while (lc1 && lc2)
4965 {
4966 if (loc_cmp (lc1->loc, lc2->loc))
4967 return true;
4968 lc1 = lc1->next;
4969 lc2 = lc2->next;
4970 }
4971
4972 return lc1 != lc2;
4973 }
4974
4975 /* Return true if one-part variables VAR1 and VAR2 are different.
4976 They must be in canonical order. */
4977
4978 static void
4979 dump_onepart_variable_differences (variable *var1, variable *var2)
4980 {
4981 location_chain *lc1, *lc2;
4982
4983 gcc_assert (var1 != var2);
4984 gcc_assert (dump_file);
4985 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (var1->dv) == dv_as_opaque (var2->dv));
4986 gcc_assert (var1->n_var_parts == 1
4987 && var2->n_var_parts == 1);
4988
4989 lc1 = var1->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4990 lc2 = var2->var_part[0].loc_chain;
4991
4992 gcc_assert (lc1 && lc2);
4993
4994 while (lc1 && lc2)
4995 {
4996 switch (loc_cmp (lc1->loc, lc2->loc))
4997 {
4998 case -1:
4999 fprintf (dump_file, "removed: ");
5000 print_rtl_single (dump_file, lc1->loc);
5001 lc1 = lc1->next;
5002 continue;
5003 case 0:
5004 break;
5005 case 1:
5006 fprintf (dump_file, "added: ");
5007 print_rtl_single (dump_file, lc2->loc);
5008 lc2 = lc2->next;
5009 continue;
5010 default:
5011 gcc_unreachable ();
5012 }
5013 lc1 = lc1->next;
5014 lc2 = lc2->next;
5015 }
5016
5017 while (lc1)
5018 {
5019 fprintf (dump_file, "removed: ");
5020 print_rtl_single (dump_file, lc1->loc);
5021 lc1 = lc1->next;
5022 }
5023
5024 while (lc2)
5025 {
5026 fprintf (dump_file, "added: ");
5027 print_rtl_single (dump_file, lc2->loc);
5028 lc2 = lc2->next;
5029 }
5030 }
5031
5032 /* Return true if variables VAR1 and VAR2 are different. */
5033
5034 static bool
5035 variable_different_p (variable *var1, variable *var2)
5036 {
5037 int i;
5038
5039 if (var1 == var2)
5040 return false;
5041
5042 if (var1->onepart != var2->onepart)
5043 return true;
5044
5045 if (var1->n_var_parts != var2->n_var_parts)
5046 return true;
5047
5048 if (var1->onepart && var1->n_var_parts)
5049 {
5050 gcc_checking_assert (dv_as_opaque (var1->dv) == dv_as_opaque (var2->dv)
5051 && var1->n_var_parts == 1);
5052 /* One-part values have locations in a canonical order. */
5053 return onepart_variable_different_p (var1, var2);
5054 }
5055
5056 for (i = 0; i < var1->n_var_parts; i++)
5057 {
5058 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (var1, i) != VAR_PART_OFFSET (var2, i))
5059 return true;
5060 if (variable_part_different_p (&var1->var_part[i], &var2->var_part[i]))
5061 return true;
5062 if (variable_part_different_p (&var2->var_part[i], &var1->var_part[i]))
5063 return true;
5064 }
5065 return false;
5066 }
5067
5068 /* Return true if dataflow sets OLD_SET and NEW_SET differ. */
5069
5070 static bool
5071 dataflow_set_different (dataflow_set *old_set, dataflow_set *new_set)
5072 {
5073 variable_iterator_type hi;
5074 variable *var1;
5075 bool diffound = false;
5076 bool details = (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS));
5077
5078 #define RETRUE \
5079 do \
5080 { \
5081 if (!details) \
5082 return true; \
5083 else \
5084 diffound = true; \
5085 } \
5086 while (0)
5087
5088 if (old_set->vars == new_set->vars)
5089 return false;
5090
5091 if (shared_hash_htab (old_set->vars)->elements ()
5092 != shared_hash_htab (new_set->vars)->elements ())
5093 RETRUE;
5094
5095 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*shared_hash_htab (old_set->vars),
5096 var1, variable, hi)
5097 {
5098 variable_table_type *htab = shared_hash_htab (new_set->vars);
5099 variable *var2 = htab->find_with_hash (var1->dv, dv_htab_hash (var1->dv));
5100
5101 if (!var2)
5102 {
5103 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
5104 {
5105 fprintf (dump_file, "dataflow difference found: removal of:\n");
5106 dump_var (var1);
5107 }
5108 RETRUE;
5109 }
5110 else if (variable_different_p (var1, var2))
5111 {
5112 if (details)
5113 {
5114 fprintf (dump_file, "dataflow difference found: "
5115 "old and new follow:\n");
5116 dump_var (var1);
5117 if (dv_onepart_p (var1->dv))
5118 dump_onepart_variable_differences (var1, var2);
5119 dump_var (var2);
5120 }
5121 RETRUE;
5122 }
5123 }
5124
5125 /* There's no need to traverse the second hashtab unless we want to
5126 print the details. If both have the same number of elements and
5127 the second one had all entries found in the first one, then the
5128 second can't have any extra entries. */
5129 if (!details)
5130 return diffound;
5131
5132 FOR_EACH_HASH_TABLE_ELEMENT (*shared_hash_htab (new_set->vars),
5133 var1, variable, hi)
5134 {
5135 variable_table_type *htab = shared_hash_htab (old_set->vars);
5136 variable *var2 = htab->find_with_hash (var1->dv, dv_htab_hash (var1->dv));
5137 if (!var2)
5138 {
5139 if (details)
5140 {
5141 fprintf (dump_file, "dataflow difference found: addition of:\n");
5142 dump_var (var1);
5143 }
5144 RETRUE;
5145 }
5146 }
5147
5148 #undef RETRUE
5149
5150 return diffound;
5151 }
5152
5153 /* Free the contents of dataflow set SET. */
5154
5155 static void
5156 dataflow_set_destroy (dataflow_set *set)
5157 {
5158 int i;
5159
5160 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
5161 attrs_list_clear (&set->regs[i]);
5162
5163 shared_hash_destroy (set->vars);
5164 set->vars = NULL;
5165 }
5166
5167 /* Return true if T is a tracked parameter with non-degenerate record type. */
5168
5169 static bool
5170 tracked_record_parameter_p (tree t)
5171 {
5172 if (TREE_CODE (t) != PARM_DECL)
5173 return false;
5174
5175 if (DECL_MODE (t) == BLKmode)
5176 return false;
5177
5178 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
5179 if (TREE_CODE (type) != RECORD_TYPE)
5180 return false;
5181
5182 if (TYPE_FIELDS (type) == NULL_TREE
5183 || DECL_CHAIN (TYPE_FIELDS (type)) == NULL_TREE)
5184 return false;
5185
5186 return true;
5187 }
5188
5189 /* Shall EXPR be tracked? */
5190
5191 static bool
5192 track_expr_p (tree expr, bool need_rtl)
5193 {
5194 rtx decl_rtl;
5195 tree realdecl;
5196
5197 if (TREE_CODE (expr) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL)
5198 return DECL_RTL_SET_P (expr);
5199
5200 /* If EXPR is not a parameter or a variable do not track it. */
5201 if (!VAR_P (expr) && TREE_CODE (expr) != PARM_DECL)
5202 return 0;
5203
5204 /* It also must have a name... */
5205 if (!DECL_NAME (expr) && need_rtl)
5206 return 0;
5207
5208 /* ... and a RTL assigned to it. */
5209 decl_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (expr);
5210 if (!decl_rtl && need_rtl)
5211 return 0;
5212
5213 /* If this expression is really a debug alias of some other declaration, we
5214 don't need to track this expression if the ultimate declaration is
5215 ignored. */
5216 realdecl = expr;
5217 if (VAR_P (realdecl) && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_EXPR_P (realdecl))
5218 {
5219 realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (realdecl);
5220 if (!DECL_P (realdecl))
5221 {
5222 if (handled_component_p (realdecl)
5223 || (TREE_CODE (realdecl) == MEM_REF
5224 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (realdecl, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR))
5225 {
5226 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
5227 bool reverse;
5228 tree innerdecl
5229 = get_ref_base_and_extent_hwi (realdecl, &bitpos,
5230 &bitsize, &reverse);
5231 if (!innerdecl
5232 || !DECL_P (innerdecl)
5233 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
5234 /* Do not track declarations for parts of tracked record
5235 parameters since we want to track them as a whole. */
5236 || tracked_record_parameter_p (innerdecl)
5237 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
5238 || bitsize == 0
5239 || bitpos + bitsize > 256)
5240 return 0;
5241 else
5242 realdecl = expr;
5243 }
5244 else
5245 return 0;
5246 }
5247 }
5248
5249 /* Do not track EXPR if REALDECL it should be ignored for debugging
5250 purposes. */
5251 if (DECL_IGNORED_P (realdecl))
5252 return 0;
5253
5254 /* Do not track global variables until we are able to emit correct location
5255 list for them. */
5256 if (TREE_STATIC (realdecl))
5257 return 0;
5258
5259 /* When the EXPR is a DECL for alias of some variable (see example)
5260 the TREE_STATIC flag is not used. Disable tracking all DECLs whose
5261 DECL_RTL contains SYMBOL_REF.
5262
5263 Example:
5264 extern char **_dl_argv_internal __attribute__ ((alias ("_dl_argv")));
5265 char **_dl_argv;
5266 */
5267 if (decl_rtl && MEM_P (decl_rtl)
5268 && contains_symbol_ref_p (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))
5269 return 0;
5270
5271 /* If RTX is a memory it should not be very large (because it would be
5272 an array or struct). */
5273 if (decl_rtl && MEM_P (decl_rtl))
5274 {
5275 /* Do not track structures and arrays. */
5276 if ((GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == BLKmode
5277 || AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (realdecl)))
5278 && !tracked_record_parameter_p (realdecl))
5279 return 0;
5280 if (MEM_SIZE_KNOWN_P (decl_rtl)
5281 && maybe_gt (MEM_SIZE (decl_rtl), MAX_VAR_PARTS))
5282 return 0;
5283 }
5284
5285 DECL_CHANGED (expr) = 0;
5286 DECL_CHANGED (realdecl) = 0;
5287 return 1;
5288 }
5289
5290 /* Determine whether a given LOC refers to the same variable part as
5291 EXPR+OFFSET. */
5292
5293 static bool
5294 same_variable_part_p (rtx loc, tree expr, poly_int64 offset)
5295 {
5296 tree expr2;
5297 poly_int64 offset2;
5298
5299 if (! DECL_P (expr))
5300 return false;
5301
5302 if (REG_P (loc))
5303 {
5304 expr2 = REG_EXPR (loc);
5305 offset2 = REG_OFFSET (loc);
5306 }
5307 else if (MEM_P (loc))
5308 {
5309 expr2 = MEM_EXPR (loc);
5310 offset2 = int_mem_offset (loc);
5311 }
5312 else
5313 return false;
5314
5315 if (! expr2 || ! DECL_P (expr2))
5316 return false;
5317
5318 expr = var_debug_decl (expr);
5319 expr2 = var_debug_decl (expr2);
5320
5321 return (expr == expr2 && known_eq (offset, offset2));
5322 }
5323
5324 /* LOC is a REG or MEM that we would like to track if possible.
5325 If EXPR is null, we don't know what expression LOC refers to,
5326 otherwise it refers to EXPR + OFFSET. STORE_REG_P is true if
5327 LOC is an lvalue register.
5328
5329 Return true if EXPR is nonnull and if LOC, or some lowpart of it,
5330 is something we can track. When returning true, store the mode of
5331 the lowpart we can track in *MODE_OUT (if nonnull) and its offset
5332 from EXPR in *OFFSET_OUT (if nonnull). */
5333
5334 static bool
5335 track_loc_p (rtx loc, tree expr, poly_int64 offset, bool store_reg_p,
5336 machine_mode *mode_out, HOST_WIDE_INT *offset_out)
5337 {
5338 machine_mode mode;
5339
5340 if (expr == NULL || !track_expr_p (expr, true))
5341 return false;
5342
5343 /* If REG was a paradoxical subreg, its REG_ATTRS will describe the
5344 whole subreg, but only the old inner part is really relevant. */
5345 mode = GET_MODE (loc);
5346 if (REG_P (loc) && !HARD_REGISTER_NUM_P (ORIGINAL_REGNO (loc)))
5347 {
5348 machine_mode pseudo_mode;
5349
5350 pseudo_mode = PSEUDO_REGNO_MODE (ORIGINAL_REGNO (loc));
5351 if (paradoxical_subreg_p (mode, pseudo_mode))
5352 {
5353 offset += byte_lowpart_offset (pseudo_mode, mode);
5354 mode = pseudo_mode;
5355 }
5356 }
5357
5358 /* If LOC is a paradoxical lowpart of EXPR, refer to EXPR itself.
5359 Do the same if we are storing to a register and EXPR occupies
5360 the whole of register LOC; in that case, the whole of EXPR is
5361 being changed. We exclude complex modes from the second case
5362 because the real and imaginary parts are represented as separate
5363 pseudo registers, even if the whole complex value fits into one
5364 hard register. */
5365 if ((paradoxical_subreg_p (mode, DECL_MODE (expr))
5366 || (store_reg_p
5367 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (DECL_MODE (expr))
5368 && hard_regno_nregs (REGNO (loc), DECL_MODE (expr)) == 1))
5369 && known_eq (offset + byte_lowpart_offset (DECL_MODE (expr), mode), 0))
5370 {
5371 mode = DECL_MODE (expr);
5372 offset = 0;
5373 }
5374
5375 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
5376 if (!track_offset_p (offset, &const_offset))
5377 return false;
5378
5379 if (mode_out)
5380 *mode_out = mode;
5381 if (offset_out)
5382 *offset_out = const_offset;
5383 return true;
5384 }
5385
5386 /* Return the MODE lowpart of LOC, or null if LOC is not something we
5387 want to track. When returning nonnull, make sure that the attributes
5388 on the returned value are updated. */
5389
5390 static rtx
5391 var_lowpart (machine_mode mode, rtx loc)
5392 {
5393 unsigned int regno;
5394
5395 if (GET_MODE (loc) == mode)
5396 return loc;
5397
5398 if (!REG_P (loc) && !MEM_P (loc))
5399 return NULL;
5400
5401 poly_uint64 offset = byte_lowpart_offset (mode, GET_MODE (loc));
5402
5403 if (MEM_P (loc))
5404 return adjust_address_nv (loc, mode, offset);
5405
5406 poly_uint64 reg_offset = subreg_lowpart_offset (mode, GET_MODE (loc));
5407 regno = REGNO (loc) + subreg_regno_offset (REGNO (loc), GET_MODE (loc),
5408 reg_offset, mode);
5409 return gen_rtx_REG_offset (loc, mode, regno, offset);
5410 }
5411
5412 /* Carry information about uses and stores while walking rtx. */
5413
5414 struct count_use_info
5415 {
5416 /* The insn where the RTX is. */
5417 rtx_insn *insn;
5418
5419 /* The basic block where insn is. */
5420 basic_block bb;
5421
5422 /* The array of n_sets sets in the insn, as determined by cselib. */
5423 struct cselib_set *sets;
5424 int n_sets;
5425
5426 /* True if we're counting stores, false otherwise. */
5427 bool store_p;
5428 };
5429
5430 /* Find a VALUE corresponding to X. */
5431
5432 static inline cselib_val *
5433 find_use_val (rtx x, machine_mode mode, struct count_use_info *cui)
5434 {
5435 int i;
5436
5437 if (cui->sets)
5438 {
5439 /* This is called after uses are set up and before stores are
5440 processed by cselib, so it's safe to look up srcs, but not
5441 dsts. So we look up expressions that appear in srcs or in
5442 dest expressions, but we search the sets array for dests of
5443 stores. */
5444 if (cui->store_p)
5445 {
5446 /* Some targets represent memset and memcpy patterns
5447 by (set (mem:BLK ...) (reg:[QHSD]I ...)) or
5448 (set (mem:BLK ...) (const_int ...)) or
5449 (set (mem:BLK ...) (mem:BLK ...)). Don't return anything
5450 in that case, otherwise we end up with mode mismatches. */
5451 if (mode == BLKmode && MEM_P (x))
5452 return NULL;
5453 for (i = 0; i < cui->n_sets; i++)
5454 if (cui->sets[i].dest == x)
5455 return cui->sets[i].src_elt;
5456 }
5457 else
5458 return cselib_lookup (x, mode, 0, VOIDmode);
5459 }
5460
5461 return NULL;
5462 }
5463
5464 /* Replace all registers and addresses in an expression with VALUE
5465 expressions that map back to them, unless the expression is a
5466 register. If no mapping is or can be performed, returns NULL. */
5467
5468 static rtx
5469 replace_expr_with_values (rtx loc)
5470 {
5471 if (REG_P (loc) || GET_CODE (loc) == ENTRY_VALUE)
5472 return NULL;
5473 else if (MEM_P (loc))
5474 {
5475 cselib_val *addr = cselib_lookup (XEXP (loc, 0),
5476 get_address_mode (loc), 0,
5477 GET_MODE (loc));
5478 if (addr)
5479 return replace_equiv_address_nv (loc, addr->val_rtx);
5480 else
5481 return NULL;
5482 }
5483 else
5484 return cselib_subst_to_values (loc, VOIDmode);
5485 }
5486
5487 /* Return true if X contains a DEBUG_EXPR. */
5488
5489 static bool
5490 rtx_debug_expr_p (const_rtx x)
5491 {
5492 subrtx_iterator::array_type array;
5493 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX (iter, array, x, ALL)
5494 if (GET_CODE (*iter) == DEBUG_EXPR)
5495 return true;
5496 return false;
5497 }
5498
5499 /* Determine what kind of micro operation to choose for a USE. Return
5500 MO_CLOBBER if no micro operation is to be generated. */
5501
5502 static enum micro_operation_type
5503 use_type (rtx loc, struct count_use_info *cui, machine_mode *modep)
5504 {
5505 tree expr;
5506
5507 if (cui && cui->sets)
5508 {
5509 if (GET_CODE (loc) == VAR_LOCATION)
5510 {
5511 if (track_expr_p (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc), false))
5512 {
5513 rtx ploc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc);
5514 if (! VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (ploc))
5515 {
5516 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup (ploc, GET_MODE (loc), 1,
5517 VOIDmode);
5518
5519 /* ??? flag_float_store and volatile mems are never
5520 given values, but we could in theory use them for
5521 locations. */
5522 gcc_assert (val || 1);
5523 }
5524 return MO_VAL_LOC;
5525 }
5526 else
5527 return MO_CLOBBER;
5528 }
5529
5530 if (REG_P (loc) || MEM_P (loc))
5531 {
5532 if (modep)
5533 *modep = GET_MODE (loc);
5534 if (cui->store_p)
5535 {
5536 if (REG_P (loc)
5537 || (find_use_val (loc, GET_MODE (loc), cui)
5538 && cselib_lookup (XEXP (loc, 0),
5539 get_address_mode (loc), 0,
5540 GET_MODE (loc))))
5541 return MO_VAL_SET;
5542 }
5543 else
5544 {
5545 cselib_val *val = find_use_val (loc, GET_MODE (loc), cui);
5546
5547 if (val && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5548 return MO_VAL_USE;
5549 }
5550 }
5551 }
5552
5553 if (REG_P (loc))
5554 {
5555 gcc_assert (REGNO (loc) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
5556
5557 if (loc == cfa_base_rtx)
5558 return MO_CLOBBER;
5559 expr = REG_EXPR (loc);
5560
5561 if (!expr)
5562 return MO_USE_NO_VAR;
5563 else if (target_for_debug_bind (var_debug_decl (expr)))
5564 return MO_CLOBBER;
5565 else if (track_loc_p (loc, expr, REG_OFFSET (loc),
5566 false, modep, NULL))
5567 return MO_USE;
5568 else
5569 return MO_USE_NO_VAR;
5570 }
5571 else if (MEM_P (loc))
5572 {
5573 expr = MEM_EXPR (loc);
5574
5575 if (!expr)
5576 return MO_CLOBBER;
5577 else if (target_for_debug_bind (var_debug_decl (expr)))
5578 return MO_CLOBBER;
5579 else if (track_loc_p (loc, expr, int_mem_offset (loc),
5580 false, modep, NULL)
5581 /* Multi-part variables shouldn't refer to one-part
5582 variable names such as VALUEs (never happens) or
5583 DEBUG_EXPRs (only happens in the presence of debug
5584 insns). */
5585 && (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS
5586 || !rtx_debug_expr_p (XEXP (loc, 0))))
5587 return MO_USE;
5588 else
5589 return MO_CLOBBER;
5590 }
5591
5592 return MO_CLOBBER;
5593 }
5594
5595 /* Log to OUT information about micro-operation MOPT involving X in
5596 INSN of BB. */
5597
5598 static inline void
5599 log_op_type (rtx x, basic_block bb, rtx_insn *insn,
5600 enum micro_operation_type mopt, FILE *out)
5601 {
5602 fprintf (out, "bb %i op %i insn %i %s ",
5603 bb->index, VTI (bb)->mos.length (),
5604 INSN_UID (insn), micro_operation_type_name[mopt]);
5605 print_inline_rtx (out, x, 2);
5606 fputc ('\n', out);
5607 }
5608
5609 /* Tell whether the CONCAT used to holds a VALUE and its location
5610 needs value resolution, i.e., an attempt of mapping the location
5611 back to other incoming values. */
5612 #define VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION(x) \
5613 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION", (x), CONCAT)->volatil)
5614 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT is a tracked expression, that
5615 should also be handled like a MO_USE. */
5616 #define VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR(x) \
5617 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR", (x), CONCAT)->used)
5618 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT should be handled like a MO_COPY
5619 as well. */
5620 #define VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED(x) \
5621 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED", (x), CONCAT)->jump)
5622 /* Whether the location in the CONCAT should be handled like a
5623 MO_CLOBBER as well. */
5624 #define VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED(x) \
5625 (RTL_FLAG_CHECK1 ("VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED", (x), CONCAT)->unchanging)
5626
5627 /* All preserved VALUEs. */
5628 static vec<rtx> preserved_values;
5629
5630 /* Ensure VAL is preserved and remember it in a vector for vt_emit_notes. */
5631
5632 static void
5633 preserve_value (cselib_val *val)
5634 {
5635 cselib_preserve_value (val);
5636 preserved_values.safe_push (val->val_rtx);
5637 }
5638
5639 /* Helper function for MO_VAL_LOC handling. Return non-zero if
5640 any rtxes not suitable for CONST use not replaced by VALUEs
5641 are discovered. */
5642
5643 static bool
5644 non_suitable_const (const_rtx x)
5645 {
5646 subrtx_iterator::array_type array;
5647 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX (iter, array, x, ALL)
5648 {
5649 const_rtx x = *iter;
5650 switch (GET_CODE (x))
5651 {
5652 case REG:
5653 case DEBUG_EXPR:
5654 case PC:
5655 case SCRATCH:
5656 case CC0:
5657 case ASM_INPUT:
5658 case ASM_OPERANDS:
5659 return true;
5660 case MEM:
5661 if (!MEM_READONLY_P (x))
5662 return true;
5663 break;
5664 default:
5665 break;
5666 }
5667 }
5668 return false;
5669 }
5670
5671 /* Add uses (register and memory references) LOC which will be tracked
5672 to VTI (bb)->mos. */
5673
5674 static void
5675 add_uses (rtx loc, struct count_use_info *cui)
5676 {
5677 machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
5678 enum micro_operation_type type = use_type (loc, cui, &mode);
5679
5680 if (type != MO_CLOBBER)
5681 {
5682 basic_block bb = cui->bb;
5683 micro_operation mo;
5684
5685 mo.type = type;
5686 mo.u.loc = type == MO_USE ? var_lowpart (mode, loc) : loc;
5687 mo.insn = cui->insn;
5688
5689 if (type == MO_VAL_LOC)
5690 {
5691 rtx oloc = loc;
5692 rtx vloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc);
5693 cselib_val *val;
5694
5695 gcc_assert (cui->sets);
5696
5697 if (MEM_P (vloc)
5698 && !REG_P (XEXP (vloc, 0))
5699 && !MEM_P (XEXP (vloc, 0)))
5700 {
5701 rtx mloc = vloc;
5702 machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (mloc);
5703 cselib_val *val
5704 = cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc, 0), address_mode, 0,
5705 GET_MODE (mloc));
5706
5707 if (val && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5708 preserve_value (val);
5709 }
5710
5711 if (CONSTANT_P (vloc)
5712 && (GET_CODE (vloc) != CONST || non_suitable_const (vloc)))
5713 /* For constants don't look up any value. */;
5714 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (vloc) && !unsuitable_loc (vloc)
5715 && (val = find_use_val (vloc, GET_MODE (oloc), cui)))
5716 {
5717 machine_mode mode2;
5718 enum micro_operation_type type2;
5719 rtx nloc = NULL;
5720 bool resolvable = REG_P (vloc) || MEM_P (vloc);
5721
5722 if (resolvable)
5723 nloc = replace_expr_with_values (vloc);
5724
5725 if (nloc)
5726 {
5727 oloc = shallow_copy_rtx (oloc);
5728 PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc) = nloc;
5729 }
5730
5731 oloc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, val->val_rtx, oloc);
5732
5733 type2 = use_type (vloc, 0, &mode2);
5734
5735 gcc_assert (type2 == MO_USE || type2 == MO_USE_NO_VAR
5736 || type2 == MO_CLOBBER);
5737
5738 if (type2 == MO_CLOBBER
5739 && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5740 {
5741 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (oloc) = resolvable;
5742 preserve_value (val);
5743 }
5744 }
5745 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (vloc))
5746 {
5747 oloc = shallow_copy_rtx (oloc);
5748 PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (oloc) = gen_rtx_UNKNOWN_VAR_LOC ();
5749 }
5750
5751 mo.u.loc = oloc;
5752 }
5753 else if (type == MO_VAL_USE)
5754 {
5755 machine_mode mode2 = VOIDmode;
5756 enum micro_operation_type type2;
5757 cselib_val *val = find_use_val (loc, GET_MODE (loc), cui);
5758 rtx vloc, oloc = loc, nloc;
5759
5760 gcc_assert (cui->sets);
5761
5762 if (MEM_P (oloc)
5763 && !REG_P (XEXP (oloc, 0))
5764 && !MEM_P (XEXP (oloc, 0)))
5765 {
5766 rtx mloc = oloc;
5767 machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (mloc);
5768 cselib_val *val
5769 = cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc, 0), address_mode, 0,
5770 GET_MODE (mloc));
5771
5772 if (val && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5773 preserve_value (val);
5774 }
5775
5776 type2 = use_type (loc, 0, &mode2);
5777
5778 gcc_assert (type2 == MO_USE || type2 == MO_USE_NO_VAR
5779 || type2 == MO_CLOBBER);
5780
5781 if (type2 == MO_USE)
5782 vloc = var_lowpart (mode2, loc);
5783 else
5784 vloc = oloc;
5785
5786 /* The loc of a MO_VAL_USE may have two forms:
5787
5788 (concat val src): val is at src, a value-based
5789 representation.
5790
5791 (concat (concat val use) src): same as above, with use as
5792 the MO_USE tracked value, if it differs from src.
5793
5794 */
5795
5796 gcc_checking_assert (REG_P (loc) || MEM_P (loc));
5797 nloc = replace_expr_with_values (loc);
5798 if (!nloc)
5799 nloc = oloc;
5800
5801 if (vloc != nloc)
5802 oloc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode2, val->val_rtx, vloc);
5803 else
5804 oloc = val->val_rtx;
5805
5806 mo.u.loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, oloc, nloc);
5807
5808 if (type2 == MO_USE)
5809 VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (mo.u.loc) = 1;
5810 if (!cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
5811 {
5812 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (mo.u.loc) = 1;
5813 preserve_value (val);
5814 }
5815 }
5816 else
5817 gcc_assert (type == MO_USE || type == MO_USE_NO_VAR);
5818
5819 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
5820 log_op_type (mo.u.loc, cui->bb, cui->insn, mo.type, dump_file);
5821 VTI (bb)->mos.safe_push (mo);
5822 }
5823 }
5824
5825 /* Helper function for finding all uses of REG/MEM in X in insn INSN. */
5826
5827 static void
5828 add_uses_1 (rtx *x, void *cui)
5829 {
5830 subrtx_var_iterator::array_type array;
5831 FOR_EACH_SUBRTX_VAR (iter, array, *x, NONCONST)
5832 add_uses (*iter, (struct count_use_info *) cui);
5833 }
5834
5835 /* This is the value used during expansion of locations. We want it
5836 to be unbounded, so that variables expanded deep in a recursion
5837 nest are fully evaluated, so that their values are cached
5838 correctly. We avoid recursion cycles through other means, and we
5839 don't unshare RTL, so excess complexity is not a problem. */
5840 #define EXPR_DEPTH (INT_MAX)
5841 /* We use this to keep too-complex expressions from being emitted as
5842 location notes, and then to debug information. Users can trade
5843 compile time for ridiculously complex expressions, although they're
5844 seldom useful, and they may often have to be discarded as not
5845 representable anyway. */
5846 #define EXPR_USE_DEPTH (PARAM_VALUE (PARAM_MAX_VARTRACK_EXPR_DEPTH))
5847
5848 /* Attempt to reverse the EXPR operation in the debug info and record
5849 it in the cselib table. Say for reg1 = reg2 + 6 even when reg2 is
5850 no longer live we can express its value as VAL - 6. */
5851
5852 static void
5853 reverse_op (rtx val, const_rtx expr, rtx_insn *insn)
5854 {
5855 rtx src, arg, ret;
5856 cselib_val *v;
5857 struct elt_loc_list *l;
5858 enum rtx_code code;
5859 int count;
5860
5861 if (GET_CODE (expr) != SET)
5862 return;
5863
5864 if (!REG_P (SET_DEST (expr)) || GET_MODE (val) != GET_MODE (SET_DEST (expr)))
5865 return;
5866
5867 src = SET_SRC (expr);
5868 switch (GET_CODE (src))
5869 {
5870 case PLUS:
5871 case MINUS:
5872 case XOR:
5873 case NOT:
5874 case NEG:
5875 if (!REG_P (XEXP (src, 0)))
5876 return;
5877 break;
5878 case SIGN_EXTEND:
5879 case ZERO_EXTEND:
5880 if (!REG_P (XEXP (src, 0)) && !MEM_P (XEXP (src, 0)))
5881 return;
5882 break;
5883 default:
5884 return;
5885 }
5886
5887 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (src)) || XEXP (src, 0) == cfa_base_rtx)
5888 return;
5889
5890 v = cselib_lookup (XEXP (src, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)), 0, VOIDmode);
5891 if (!v || !cselib_preserved_value_p (v))
5892 return;
5893
5894 /* Use canonical V to avoid creating multiple redundant expressions
5895 for different VALUES equivalent to V. */
5896 v = canonical_cselib_val (v);
5897
5898 /* Adding a reverse op isn't useful if V already has an always valid
5899 location. Ignore ENTRY_VALUE, while it is always constant, we should
5900 prefer non-ENTRY_VALUE locations whenever possible. */
5901 for (l = v->locs, count = 0; l; l = l->next, count++)
5902 if (CONSTANT_P (l->loc)
5903 && (GET_CODE (l->loc) != CONST || !references_value_p (l->loc, 0)))
5904 return;
5905 /* Avoid creating too large locs lists. */
5906 else if (count == PARAM_VALUE (PARAM_MAX_VARTRACK_REVERSE_OP_SIZE))
5907 return;
5908
5909 switch (GET_CODE (src))
5910 {
5911 case NOT:
5912 case NEG:
5913 if (GET_MODE (v->val_rtx) != GET_MODE (val))
5914 return;
5915 ret = gen_rtx_fmt_e (GET_CODE (src), GET_MODE (val), val);
5916 break;
5917 case SIGN_EXTEND:
5918 case ZERO_EXTEND:
5919 ret = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (GET_MODE (v->val_rtx), val);
5920 break;
5921 case XOR:
5922 code = XOR;
5923 goto binary;
5924 case PLUS:
5925 code = MINUS;
5926 goto binary;
5927 case MINUS:
5928 code = PLUS;
5929 goto binary;
5930 binary:
5931 if (GET_MODE (v->val_rtx) != GET_MODE (val))
5932 return;
5933 arg = XEXP (src, 1);
5934 if (!CONST_INT_P (arg) && GET_CODE (arg) != SYMBOL_REF)
5935 {
5936 arg = cselib_expand_value_rtx (arg, scratch_regs, 5);
5937 if (arg == NULL_RTX)
5938 return;
5939 if (!CONST_INT_P (arg) && GET_CODE (arg) != SYMBOL_REF)
5940 return;
5941 }
5942 ret = simplify_gen_binary (code, GET_MODE (val), val, arg);
5943 break;
5944 default:
5945 gcc_unreachable ();
5946 }
5947
5948 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (v, ret, insn);
5949 }
5950
5951 /* Add stores (register and memory references) LOC which will be tracked
5952 to VTI (bb)->mos. EXPR is the RTL expression containing the store.
5953 CUIP->insn is instruction which the LOC is part of. */
5954
5955 static void
5956 add_stores (rtx loc, const_rtx expr, void *cuip)
5957 {
5958 machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, mode2;
5959 struct count_use_info *cui = (struct count_use_info *)cuip;
5960 basic_block bb = cui->bb;
5961 micro_operation mo;
5962 rtx oloc = loc, nloc, src = NULL;
5963 enum micro_operation_type type = use_type (loc, cui, &mode);
5964 bool track_p = false;
5965 cselib_val *v;
5966 bool resolve, preserve;
5967
5968 if (type == MO_CLOBBER)
5969 return;
5970
5971 mode2 = mode;
5972
5973 if (REG_P (loc))
5974 {
5975 gcc_assert (loc != cfa_base_rtx);
5976 if ((GET_CODE (expr) == CLOBBER && type != MO_VAL_SET)
5977 || !(track_p = use_type (loc, NULL, &mode2) == MO_USE)
5978 || GET_CODE (expr) == CLOBBER)
5979 {
5980 mo.type = MO_CLOBBER;
5981 mo.u.loc = loc;
5982 if (GET_CODE (expr) == SET
5983 && (SET_DEST (expr) == loc
5984 || (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (expr)) == STRICT_LOW_PART
5985 && XEXP (SET_DEST (expr), 0) == loc))
5986 && !unsuitable_loc (SET_SRC (expr))
5987 && find_use_val (loc, mode, cui))
5988 {
5989 gcc_checking_assert (type == MO_VAL_SET);
5990 mo.u.loc = gen_rtx_SET (loc, SET_SRC (expr));
5991 }
5992 }
5993 else
5994 {
5995 if (GET_CODE (expr) == SET
5996 && SET_DEST (expr) == loc
5997 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (expr)) != ASM_OPERANDS)
5998 src = var_lowpart (mode2, SET_SRC (expr));
5999 loc = var_lowpart (mode2, loc);
6000
6001 if (src == NULL)
6002 {
6003 mo.type = MO_SET;
6004 mo.u.loc = loc;
6005 }
6006 else
6007 {
6008 rtx xexpr = gen_rtx_SET (loc, src);
6009 if (same_variable_part_p (src, REG_EXPR (loc), REG_OFFSET (loc)))
6010 {
6011 /* If this is an instruction copying (part of) a parameter
6012 passed by invisible reference to its register location,
6013 pretend it's a SET so that the initial memory location
6014 is discarded, as the parameter register can be reused
6015 for other purposes and we do not track locations based
6016 on generic registers. */
6017 if (MEM_P (src)
6018 && REG_EXPR (loc)
6019 && TREE_CODE (REG_EXPR (loc)) == PARM_DECL
6020 && DECL_MODE (REG_EXPR (loc)) != BLKmode
6021 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (REG_EXPR (loc)))
6022 && XEXP (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (REG_EXPR (loc)), 0)
6023 != arg_pointer_rtx)
6024 mo.type = MO_SET;
6025 else
6026 mo.type = MO_COPY;
6027 }
6028 else
6029 mo.type = MO_SET;
6030 mo.u.loc = xexpr;
6031 }
6032 }
6033 mo.insn = cui->insn;
6034 }
6035 else if (MEM_P (loc)
6036 && ((track_p = use_type (loc, NULL, &mode2) == MO_USE)
6037 || cui->sets))
6038 {
6039 if (MEM_P (loc) && type == MO_VAL_SET
6040 && !REG_P (XEXP (loc, 0))
6041 && !MEM_P (XEXP (loc, 0)))
6042 {
6043 rtx mloc = loc;
6044 machine_mode address_mode = get_address_mode (mloc);
6045 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup (XEXP (mloc, 0),
6046 address_mode, 0,
6047 GET_MODE (mloc));
6048
6049 if (val && !cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
6050 preserve_value (val);
6051 }
6052
6053 if (GET_CODE (expr) == CLOBBER || !track_p)
6054 {
6055 mo.type = MO_CLOBBER;
6056 mo.u.loc = track_p ? var_lowpart (mode2, loc) : loc;
6057 }
6058 else
6059 {
6060 if (GET_CODE (expr) == SET
6061 && SET_DEST (expr) == loc
6062 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (expr)) != ASM_OPERANDS)
6063 src = var_lowpart (mode2, SET_SRC (expr));
6064 loc = var_lowpart (mode2, loc);
6065
6066 if (src == NULL)
6067 {
6068 mo.type = MO_SET;
6069 mo.u.loc = loc;
6070 }
6071 else
6072 {
6073 rtx xexpr = gen_rtx_SET (loc, src);
6074 if (same_variable_part_p (SET_SRC (xexpr),
6075 MEM_EXPR (loc),
6076 int_mem_offset (loc)))
6077 mo.type = MO_COPY;
6078 else
6079 mo.type = MO_SET;
6080 mo.u.loc = xexpr;
6081 }
6082 }
6083 mo.insn = cui->insn;
6084 }
6085 else
6086 return;
6087
6088 if (type != MO_VAL_SET)
6089 goto log_and_return;
6090
6091 v = find_use_val (oloc, mode, cui);
6092
6093 if (!v)
6094 goto log_and_return;
6095
6096 resolve = preserve = !cselib_preserved_value_p (v);
6097
6098 /* We cannot track values for multiple-part variables, so we track only
6099 locations for tracked record parameters. */
6100 if (track_p
6101 && REG_P (loc)
6102 && REG_EXPR (loc)
6103 && tracked_record_parameter_p (REG_EXPR (loc)))
6104 {
6105 /* Although we don't use the value here, it could be used later by the
6106 mere virtue of its existence as the operand of the reverse operation
6107 that gave rise to it (typically extension/truncation). Make sure it
6108 is preserved as required by vt_expand_var_loc_chain. */
6109 if (preserve)
6110 preserve_value (v);
6111 goto log_and_return;
6112 }
6113
6114 if (loc == stack_pointer_rtx
6115 && maybe_ne (hard_frame_pointer_adjustment, -1)
6116 && preserve)
6117 cselib_set_value_sp_based (v);
6118
6119 nloc = replace_expr_with_values (oloc);
6120 if (nloc)
6121 oloc = nloc;
6122
6123 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (cui->insn)) == COND_EXEC)
6124 {
6125 cselib_val *oval = cselib_lookup (oloc, GET_MODE (oloc), 0, VOIDmode);
6126
6127 if (oval == v)
6128 return;
6129 gcc_assert (REG_P (oloc) || MEM_P (oloc));
6130
6131 if (oval && !cselib_preserved_value_p (oval))
6132 {
6133 micro_operation moa;
6134
6135 preserve_value (oval);
6136
6137 moa.type = MO_VAL_USE;
6138 moa.u.loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, oval->val_rtx, oloc);
6139 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (moa.u.loc) = 1;
6140 moa.insn = cui->insn;
6141
6142 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6143 log_op_type (moa.u.loc, cui->bb, cui->insn,
6144 moa.type, dump_file);
6145 VTI (bb)->mos.safe_push (moa);
6146 }
6147
6148 resolve = false;
6149 }
6150 else if (resolve && GET_CODE (mo.u.loc) == SET)
6151 {
6152 if (REG_P (SET_SRC (expr)) || MEM_P (SET_SRC (expr)))
6153 nloc = replace_expr_with_values (SET_SRC (expr));
6154 else
6155 nloc = NULL_RTX;
6156
6157 /* Avoid the mode mismatch between oexpr and expr. */
6158 if (!nloc && mode != mode2)
6159 {
6160 nloc = SET_SRC (expr);
6161 gcc_assert (oloc == SET_DEST (expr));
6162 }
6163
6164 if (nloc && nloc != SET_SRC (mo.u.loc))
6165 oloc = gen_rtx_SET (oloc, nloc);
6166 else
6167 {
6168 if (oloc == SET_DEST (mo.u.loc))
6169 /* No point in duplicating. */
6170 oloc = mo.u.loc;
6171 if (!REG_P (SET_SRC (mo.u.loc)))
6172 resolve = false;
6173 }
6174 }
6175 else if (!resolve)
6176 {
6177 if (GET_CODE (mo.u.loc) == SET
6178 && oloc == SET_DEST (mo.u.loc))
6179 /* No point in duplicating. */
6180 oloc = mo.u.loc;
6181 }
6182 else
6183 resolve = false;
6184
6185 loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, v->val_rtx, oloc);
6186
6187 if (mo.u.loc != oloc)
6188 loc = gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (mo.u.loc), loc, mo.u.loc);
6189
6190 /* The loc of a MO_VAL_SET may have various forms:
6191
6192 (concat val dst): dst now holds val
6193
6194 (concat val (set dst src)): dst now holds val, copied from src
6195
6196 (concat (concat val dstv) dst): dst now holds val; dstv is dst
6197 after replacing mems and non-top-level regs with values.
6198
6199 (concat (concat val dstv) (set dst src)): dst now holds val,
6200 copied from src. dstv is a value-based representation of dst, if
6201 it differs from dst. If resolution is needed, src is a REG, and
6202 its mode is the same as that of val.
6203
6204 (concat (concat val (set dstv srcv)) (set dst src)): src
6205 copied to dst, holding val. dstv and srcv are value-based
6206 representations of dst and src, respectively.
6207
6208 */
6209
6210 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (cui->insn)) != COND_EXEC)
6211 reverse_op (v->val_rtx, expr, cui->insn);
6212
6213 mo.u.loc = loc;
6214
6215 if (track_p)
6216 VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc) = 1;
6217 if (preserve)
6218 {
6219 VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc) = resolve;
6220 preserve_value (v);
6221 }
6222 if (mo.type == MO_CLOBBER)
6223 VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc) = 1;
6224 if (mo.type == MO_COPY)
6225 VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc) = 1;
6226
6227 mo.type = MO_VAL_SET;
6228
6229 log_and_return:
6230 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6231 log_op_type (mo.u.loc, cui->bb, cui->insn, mo.type, dump_file);
6232 VTI (bb)->mos.safe_push (mo);
6233 }
6234
6235 /* Arguments to the call. */
6236 static rtx call_arguments;
6237
6238 /* Compute call_arguments. */
6239
6240 static void
6241 prepare_call_arguments (basic_block bb, rtx_insn *insn)
6242 {
6243 rtx link, x, call;
6244 rtx prev, cur, next;
6245 rtx this_arg = NULL_RTX;
6246 tree type = NULL_TREE, t, fndecl = NULL_TREE;
6247 tree obj_type_ref = NULL_TREE;
6248 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far_v;
6249 cumulative_args_t args_so_far;
6250
6251 memset (&args_so_far_v, 0, sizeof (args_so_far_v));
6252 args_so_far = pack_cumulative_args (&args_so_far_v);
6253 call = get_call_rtx_from (insn);
6254 if (call)
6255 {
6256 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (call, 0), 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
6257 {
6258 rtx symbol = XEXP (XEXP (call, 0), 0);
6259 if (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (symbol))
6260 fndecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (symbol);
6261 }
6262 if (fndecl == NULL_TREE)
6263 fndecl = MEM_EXPR (XEXP (call, 0));
6264 if (fndecl
6265 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl)) != FUNCTION_TYPE
6266 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (fndecl)) != METHOD_TYPE)
6267 fndecl = NULL_TREE;
6268 if (fndecl && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fndecl)))
6269 type = TREE_TYPE (fndecl);
6270 if (fndecl && TREE_CODE (fndecl) != FUNCTION_DECL)
6271 {
6272 if (TREE_CODE (fndecl) == INDIRECT_REF
6273 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (fndecl, 0)) == OBJ_TYPE_REF)
6274 obj_type_ref = TREE_OPERAND (fndecl, 0);
6275 fndecl = NULL_TREE;
6276 }
6277 if (type)
6278 {
6279 for (t = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type); t && t != void_list_node;
6280 t = TREE_CHAIN (t))
6281 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_VALUE (t)) == REFERENCE_TYPE
6282 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (t))))
6283 break;
6284 if ((t == NULL || t == void_list_node) && obj_type_ref == NULL_TREE)
6285 type = NULL;
6286 else
6287 {
6288 int nargs ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED = list_length (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type));
6289 link = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn);
6290 #ifndef PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
6291 if (aggregate_value_p (TREE_TYPE (type), type)
6292 && targetm.calls.struct_value_rtx (type, 0) == 0)
6293 {
6294 tree struct_addr = build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (type));
6295 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (struct_addr);
6296 rtx reg;
6297 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v, type, NULL_RTX, fndecl,
6298 nargs + 1);
6299 reg = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, mode,
6300 struct_addr, true);
6301 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (args_so_far, mode,
6302 struct_addr, true);
6303 if (reg == NULL_RTX)
6304 {
6305 for (; link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
6306 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link, 0)) == USE
6307 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0)))
6308 {
6309 link = XEXP (link, 1);
6310 break;
6311 }
6312 }
6313 }
6314 else
6315 #endif
6316 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v, type, NULL_RTX, fndecl,
6317 nargs);
6318 if (obj_type_ref && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type) != void_list_node)
6319 {
6320 machine_mode mode;
6321 t = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type);
6322 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (t));
6323 this_arg = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, mode,
6324 TREE_VALUE (t), true);
6325 if (this_arg && !REG_P (this_arg))
6326 this_arg = NULL_RTX;
6327 else if (this_arg == NULL_RTX)
6328 {
6329 for (; link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
6330 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link, 0)) == USE
6331 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0)))
6332 {
6333 this_arg = XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0);
6334 break;
6335 }
6336 }
6337 }
6338 }
6339 }
6340 }
6341 t = type ? TYPE_ARG_TYPES (type) : NULL_TREE;
6342
6343 for (link = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (insn); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
6344 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (link, 0)) == USE)
6345 {
6346 rtx item = NULL_RTX;
6347 x = XEXP (XEXP (link, 0), 0);
6348 if (GET_MODE (link) == VOIDmode
6349 || GET_MODE (link) == BLKmode
6350 || (GET_MODE (link) != GET_MODE (x)
6351 && ((GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (link)) != MODE_INT
6352 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (link)) != MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
6353 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT
6354 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_PARTIAL_INT))))
6355 /* Can't do anything for these, if the original type mode
6356 isn't known or can't be converted. */;
6357 else if (REG_P (x))
6358 {
6359 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup (x, GET_MODE (x), 0, VOIDmode);
6360 scalar_int_mode mode;
6361 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
6362 item = val->val_rtx;
6363 else if (is_a <scalar_int_mode> (GET_MODE (x), &mode))
6364 {
6365 opt_scalar_int_mode mode_iter;
6366 FOR_EACH_WIDER_MODE (mode_iter, mode)
6367 {
6368 mode = mode_iter.require ();
6369 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
6370 break;
6371
6372 rtx reg = simplify_subreg (mode, x, GET_MODE (x), 0);
6373 if (reg == NULL_RTX || !REG_P (reg))
6374 continue;
6375 val = cselib_lookup (reg, mode, 0, VOIDmode);
6376 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
6377 {
6378 item = val->val_rtx;
6379 break;
6380 }
6381 }
6382 }
6383 }
6384 else if (MEM_P (x))
6385 {
6386 rtx mem = x;
6387 cselib_val *val;
6388
6389 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
6390 {
6391 struct adjust_mem_data amd;
6392 amd.mem_mode = VOIDmode;
6393 amd.stack_adjust = -VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust;
6394 amd.store = true;
6395 mem = simplify_replace_fn_rtx (mem, NULL_RTX, adjust_mems,
6396 &amd);
6397 gcc_assert (amd.side_effects.is_empty ());
6398 }
6399 val = cselib_lookup (mem, GET_MODE (mem), 0, VOIDmode);
6400 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
6401 item = val->val_rtx;
6402 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (mem)) != MODE_INT
6403 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (mem)) != MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
6404 {
6405 /* For non-integer stack argument see also if they weren't
6406 initialized by integers. */
6407 scalar_int_mode imode;
6408 if (int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (mem)).exists (&imode)
6409 && imode != GET_MODE (mem))
6410 {
6411 val = cselib_lookup (adjust_address_nv (mem, imode, 0),
6412 imode, 0, VOIDmode);
6413 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
6414 item = lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (x), val->val_rtx,
6415 imode);
6416 }
6417 }
6418 }
6419 if (item)
6420 {
6421 rtx x2 = x;
6422 if (GET_MODE (item) != GET_MODE (link))
6423 item = lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (link), item, GET_MODE (item));
6424 if (GET_MODE (x2) != GET_MODE (link))
6425 x2 = lowpart_subreg (GET_MODE (link), x2, GET_MODE (x2));
6426 item = gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (link), x2, item);
6427 call_arguments
6428 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, item, call_arguments);
6429 }
6430 if (t && t != void_list_node)
6431 {
6432 tree argtype = TREE_VALUE (t);
6433 machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (argtype);
6434 rtx reg;
6435 if (pass_by_reference (&args_so_far_v, mode, argtype, true))
6436 {
6437 argtype = build_pointer_type (argtype);
6438 mode = TYPE_MODE (argtype);
6439 }
6440 reg = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, mode,
6441 argtype, true);
6442 if (TREE_CODE (argtype) == REFERENCE_TYPE
6443 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (argtype))
6444 && reg
6445 && REG_P (reg)
6446 && GET_MODE (reg) == mode
6447 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
6448 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
6449 && REG_P (x)
6450 && REGNO (x) == REGNO (reg)
6451 && GET_MODE (x) == mode
6452 && item)
6453 {
6454 machine_mode indmode
6455 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (argtype));
6456 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (indmode, x);
6457 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup (mem, indmode, 0, VOIDmode);
6458 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
6459 {
6460 item = gen_rtx_CONCAT (indmode, mem, val->val_rtx);
6461 call_arguments = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, item,
6462 call_arguments);
6463 }
6464 else
6465 {
6466 struct elt_loc_list *l;
6467 tree initial;
6468
6469 /* Try harder, when passing address of a constant
6470 pool integer it can be easily read back. */
6471 item = XEXP (item, 1);
6472 if (GET_CODE (item) == SUBREG)
6473 item = SUBREG_REG (item);
6474 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (item) == VALUE);
6475 val = CSELIB_VAL_PTR (item);
6476 for (l = val->locs; l; l = l->next)
6477 if (GET_CODE (l->loc) == SYMBOL_REF
6478 && TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (l->loc)
6479 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->loc)
6480 && DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->loc)))
6481 {
6482 initial = DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (l->loc));
6483 if (tree_fits_shwi_p (initial))
6484 {
6485 item = GEN_INT (tree_to_shwi (initial));
6486 item = gen_rtx_CONCAT (indmode, mem, item);
6487 call_arguments
6488 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, item,
6489 call_arguments);
6490 }
6491 break;
6492 }
6493 }
6494 }
6495 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (args_so_far, mode,
6496 argtype, true);
6497 t = TREE_CHAIN (t);
6498 }
6499 }
6500
6501 /* Add debug arguments. */
6502 if (fndecl
6503 && TREE_CODE (fndecl) == FUNCTION_DECL
6504 && DECL_HAS_DEBUG_ARGS_P (fndecl))
6505 {
6506 vec<tree, va_gc> **debug_args = decl_debug_args_lookup (fndecl);
6507 if (debug_args)
6508 {
6509 unsigned int ix;
6510 tree param;
6511 for (ix = 0; vec_safe_iterate (*debug_args, ix, &param); ix += 2)
6512 {
6513 rtx item;
6514 tree dtemp = (**debug_args)[ix + 1];
6515 machine_mode mode = DECL_MODE (dtemp);
6516 item = gen_rtx_DEBUG_PARAMETER_REF (mode, param);
6517 item = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, item, DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dtemp));
6518 call_arguments = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, item,
6519 call_arguments);
6520 }
6521 }
6522 }
6523
6524 /* Reverse call_arguments chain. */
6525 prev = NULL_RTX;
6526 for (cur = call_arguments; cur; cur = next)
6527 {
6528 next = XEXP (cur, 1);
6529 XEXP (cur, 1) = prev;
6530 prev = cur;
6531 }
6532 call_arguments = prev;
6533
6534 x = get_call_rtx_from (insn);
6535 if (x)
6536 {
6537 x = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
6538 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF)
6539 /* Don't record anything. */;
6540 else if (CONSTANT_P (x))
6541 {
6542 x = gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode ? Pmode : GET_MODE (x),
6543 pc_rtx, x);
6544 call_arguments
6545 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, call_arguments);
6546 }
6547 else
6548 {
6549 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup (x, GET_MODE (x), 0, VOIDmode);
6550 if (val && cselib_preserved_value_p (val))
6551 {
6552 x = gen_rtx_CONCAT (GET_MODE (x), pc_rtx, val->val_rtx);
6553 call_arguments
6554 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, call_arguments);
6555 }
6556 }
6557 }
6558 if (this_arg)
6559 {
6560 machine_mode mode
6561 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (obj_type_ref)));
6562 rtx clobbered = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, this_arg);
6563 HOST_WIDE_INT token
6564 = tree_to_shwi (OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN (obj_type_ref));
6565 if (token)
6566 clobbered = plus_constant (mode, clobbered,
6567 token * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
6568 clobbered = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, clobbered);
6569 x = gen_rtx_CONCAT (mode, gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, pc_rtx), clobbered);
6570 call_arguments
6571 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, x, call_arguments);
6572 }
6573 }
6574
6575 /* Callback for cselib_record_sets_hook, that records as micro
6576 operations uses and stores in an insn after cselib_record_sets has
6577 analyzed the sets in an insn, but before it modifies the stored
6578 values in the internal tables, unless cselib_record_sets doesn't
6579 call it directly (perhaps because we're not doing cselib in the
6580 first place, in which case sets and n_sets will be 0). */
6581
6582 static void
6583 add_with_sets (rtx_insn *insn, struct cselib_set *sets, int n_sets)
6584 {
6585 basic_block bb = BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn);
6586 int n1, n2;
6587 struct count_use_info cui;
6588 micro_operation *mos;
6589
6590 cselib_hook_called = true;
6591
6592 cui.insn = insn;
6593 cui.bb = bb;
6594 cui.sets = sets;
6595 cui.n_sets = n_sets;
6596
6597 n1 = VTI (bb)->mos.length ();
6598 cui.store_p = false;
6599 note_uses (&PATTERN (insn), add_uses_1, &cui);
6600 n2 = VTI (bb)->mos.length () - 1;
6601 mos = VTI (bb)->mos.address ();
6602
6603 /* Order the MO_USEs to be before MO_USE_NO_VARs and MO_VAL_USE, and
6604 MO_VAL_LOC last. */
6605 while (n1 < n2)
6606 {
6607 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n1].type == MO_USE)
6608 n1++;
6609 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n2].type != MO_USE)
6610 n2--;
6611 if (n1 < n2)
6612 std::swap (mos[n1], mos[n2]);
6613 }
6614
6615 n2 = VTI (bb)->mos.length () - 1;
6616 while (n1 < n2)
6617 {
6618 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n1].type != MO_VAL_LOC)
6619 n1++;
6620 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n2].type == MO_VAL_LOC)
6621 n2--;
6622 if (n1 < n2)
6623 std::swap (mos[n1], mos[n2]);
6624 }
6625
6626 if (CALL_P (insn))
6627 {
6628 micro_operation mo;
6629
6630 mo.type = MO_CALL;
6631 mo.insn = insn;
6632 mo.u.loc = call_arguments;
6633 call_arguments = NULL_RTX;
6634
6635 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
6636 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn), bb, insn, mo.type, dump_file);
6637 VTI (bb)->mos.safe_push (mo);
6638 }
6639
6640 n1 = VTI (bb)->mos.length ();
6641 /* This will record NEXT_INSN (insn), such that we can
6642 insert notes before it without worrying about any
6643 notes that MO_USEs might emit after the insn. */
6644 cui.store_p = true;
6645 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), add_stores, &cui);
6646 n2 = VTI (bb)->mos.length () - 1;
6647 mos = VTI (bb)->mos.address ();
6648
6649 /* Order the MO_VAL_USEs first (note_stores does nothing
6650 on DEBUG_INSNs, so there are no MO_VAL_LOCs from this
6651 insn), then MO_CLOBBERs, then MO_SET/MO_COPY/MO_VAL_SET. */
6652 while (n1 < n2)
6653 {
6654 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n1].type == MO_VAL_USE)
6655 n1++;
6656 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n2].type != MO_VAL_USE)
6657 n2--;
6658 if (n1 < n2)
6659 std::swap (mos[n1], mos[n2]);
6660 }
6661
6662 n2 = VTI (bb)->mos.length () - 1;
6663 while (n1 < n2)
6664 {
6665 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n1].type == MO_CLOBBER)
6666 n1++;
6667 while (n1 < n2 && mos[n2].type != MO_CLOBBER)
6668 n2--;
6669 if (n1 < n2)
6670 std::swap (mos[n1], mos[n2]);
6671 }
6672 }
6673
6674 static enum var_init_status
6675 find_src_status (dataflow_set *in, rtx src)
6676 {
6677 tree decl = NULL_TREE;
6678 enum var_init_status status = VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED;
6679
6680 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
6681 status = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
6682
6683 if (src && REG_P (src))
6684 decl = var_debug_decl (REG_EXPR (src));
6685 else if (src && MEM_P (src))
6686 decl = var_debug_decl (MEM_EXPR (src));
6687
6688 if (src && decl)
6689 status = get_init_value (in, src, dv_from_decl (decl));
6690
6691 return status;
6692 }
6693
6694 /* SRC is the source of an assignment. Use SET to try to find what
6695 was ultimately assigned to SRC. Return that value if known,
6696 otherwise return SRC itself. */
6697
6698 static rtx
6699 find_src_set_src (dataflow_set *set, rtx src)
6700 {
6701 tree decl = NULL_TREE; /* The variable being copied around. */
6702 rtx set_src = NULL_RTX; /* The value for "decl" stored in "src". */
6703 variable *var;
6704 location_chain *nextp;
6705 int i;
6706 bool found;
6707
6708 if (src && REG_P (src))
6709 decl = var_debug_decl (REG_EXPR (src));
6710 else if (src && MEM_P (src))
6711 decl = var_debug_decl (MEM_EXPR (src));
6712
6713 if (src && decl)
6714 {
6715 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_decl (decl);
6716
6717 var = shared_hash_find (set->vars, dv);
6718 if (var)
6719 {
6720 found = false;
6721 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts && !found; i++)
6722 for (nextp = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; nextp && !found;
6723 nextp = nextp->next)
6724 if (rtx_equal_p (nextp->loc, src))
6725 {
6726 set_src = nextp->set_src;
6727 found = true;
6728 }
6729
6730 }
6731 }
6732
6733 return set_src;
6734 }
6735
6736 /* Compute the changes of variable locations in the basic block BB. */
6737
6738 static bool
6739 compute_bb_dataflow (basic_block bb)
6740 {
6741 unsigned int i;
6742 micro_operation *mo;
6743 bool changed;
6744 dataflow_set old_out;
6745 dataflow_set *in = &VTI (bb)->in;
6746 dataflow_set *out = &VTI (bb)->out;
6747
6748 dataflow_set_init (&old_out);
6749 dataflow_set_copy (&old_out, out);
6750 dataflow_set_copy (out, in);
6751
6752 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
6753 local_get_addr_cache = new hash_map<rtx, rtx>;
6754
6755 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (VTI (bb)->mos, i, mo)
6756 {
6757 rtx_insn *insn = mo->insn;
6758
6759 switch (mo->type)
6760 {
6761 case MO_CALL:
6762 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (out, insn);
6763 break;
6764
6765 case MO_USE:
6766 {
6767 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6768
6769 if (REG_P (loc))
6770 var_reg_set (out, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED, NULL);
6771 else if (MEM_P (loc))
6772 var_mem_set (out, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED, NULL);
6773 }
6774 break;
6775
6776 case MO_VAL_LOC:
6777 {
6778 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6779 rtx val, vloc;
6780 tree var;
6781
6782 if (GET_CODE (loc) == CONCAT)
6783 {
6784 val = XEXP (loc, 0);
6785 vloc = XEXP (loc, 1);
6786 }
6787 else
6788 {
6789 val = NULL_RTX;
6790 vloc = loc;
6791 }
6792
6793 var = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (vloc);
6794
6795 clobber_variable_part (out, NULL_RTX,
6796 dv_from_decl (var), 0, NULL_RTX);
6797 if (val)
6798 {
6799 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
6800 val_resolve (out, val, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc), insn);
6801 set_variable_part (out, val, dv_from_decl (var), 0,
6802 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX,
6803 INSERT);
6804 }
6805 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc)))
6806 set_variable_part (out, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc),
6807 dv_from_decl (var), 0,
6808 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX,
6809 INSERT);
6810 }
6811 break;
6812
6813 case MO_VAL_USE:
6814 {
6815 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6816 rtx val, vloc, uloc;
6817
6818 vloc = uloc = XEXP (loc, 1);
6819 val = XEXP (loc, 0);
6820
6821 if (GET_CODE (val) == CONCAT)
6822 {
6823 uloc = XEXP (val, 1);
6824 val = XEXP (val, 0);
6825 }
6826
6827 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
6828 val_resolve (out, val, vloc, insn);
6829 else
6830 val_store (out, val, uloc, insn, false);
6831
6832 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc))
6833 {
6834 if (GET_CODE (uloc) == REG)
6835 var_reg_set (out, uloc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED,
6836 NULL);
6837 else if (GET_CODE (uloc) == MEM)
6838 var_mem_set (out, uloc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED,
6839 NULL);
6840 }
6841 }
6842 break;
6843
6844 case MO_VAL_SET:
6845 {
6846 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6847 rtx val, vloc, uloc;
6848 rtx dstv, srcv;
6849
6850 vloc = loc;
6851 uloc = XEXP (vloc, 1);
6852 val = XEXP (vloc, 0);
6853 vloc = uloc;
6854
6855 if (GET_CODE (uloc) == SET)
6856 {
6857 dstv = SET_DEST (uloc);
6858 srcv = SET_SRC (uloc);
6859 }
6860 else
6861 {
6862 dstv = uloc;
6863 srcv = NULL;
6864 }
6865
6866 if (GET_CODE (val) == CONCAT)
6867 {
6868 dstv = vloc = XEXP (val, 1);
6869 val = XEXP (val, 0);
6870 }
6871
6872 if (GET_CODE (vloc) == SET)
6873 {
6874 srcv = SET_SRC (vloc);
6875
6876 gcc_assert (val != srcv);
6877 gcc_assert (vloc == uloc || VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc));
6878
6879 dstv = vloc = SET_DEST (vloc);
6880
6881 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
6882 val_resolve (out, val, srcv, insn);
6883 }
6884 else if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
6885 {
6886 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (uloc) == SET
6887 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (uloc)) == REG);
6888 val_resolve (out, val, SET_SRC (uloc), insn);
6889 }
6890
6891 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc))
6892 {
6893 if (VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc))
6894 {
6895 if (REG_P (uloc))
6896 var_reg_delete (out, uloc, true);
6897 else if (MEM_P (uloc))
6898 {
6899 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv));
6900 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv) == MEM_ATTRS (uloc));
6901 var_mem_delete (out, dstv, true);
6902 }
6903 }
6904 else
6905 {
6906 bool copied_p = VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc);
6907 rtx src = NULL, dst = uloc;
6908 enum var_init_status status = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
6909
6910 if (GET_CODE (uloc) == SET)
6911 {
6912 src = SET_SRC (uloc);
6913 dst = SET_DEST (uloc);
6914 }
6915
6916 if (copied_p)
6917 {
6918 if (flag_var_tracking_uninit)
6919 {
6920 status = find_src_status (in, src);
6921
6922 if (status == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN)
6923 status = find_src_status (out, src);
6924 }
6925
6926 src = find_src_set_src (in, src);
6927 }
6928
6929 if (REG_P (dst))
6930 var_reg_delete_and_set (out, dst, !copied_p,
6931 status, srcv);
6932 else if (MEM_P (dst))
6933 {
6934 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv));
6935 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv) == MEM_ATTRS (dst));
6936 var_mem_delete_and_set (out, dstv, !copied_p,
6937 status, srcv);
6938 }
6939 }
6940 }
6941 else if (REG_P (uloc))
6942 var_regno_delete (out, REGNO (uloc));
6943 else if (MEM_P (uloc))
6944 {
6945 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (vloc) == MEM);
6946 gcc_checking_assert (dstv == vloc);
6947 if (dstv != vloc)
6948 clobber_overlapping_mems (out, vloc);
6949 }
6950
6951 val_store (out, val, dstv, insn, true);
6952 }
6953 break;
6954
6955 case MO_SET:
6956 {
6957 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6958 rtx set_src = NULL;
6959
6960 if (GET_CODE (loc) == SET)
6961 {
6962 set_src = SET_SRC (loc);
6963 loc = SET_DEST (loc);
6964 }
6965
6966 if (REG_P (loc))
6967 var_reg_delete_and_set (out, loc, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
6968 set_src);
6969 else if (MEM_P (loc))
6970 var_mem_delete_and_set (out, loc, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
6971 set_src);
6972 }
6973 break;
6974
6975 case MO_COPY:
6976 {
6977 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
6978 enum var_init_status src_status;
6979 rtx set_src = NULL;
6980
6981 if (GET_CODE (loc) == SET)
6982 {
6983 set_src = SET_SRC (loc);
6984 loc = SET_DEST (loc);
6985 }
6986
6987 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
6988 src_status = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
6989 else
6990 {
6991 src_status = find_src_status (in, set_src);
6992
6993 if (src_status == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN)
6994 src_status = find_src_status (out, set_src);
6995 }
6996
6997 set_src = find_src_set_src (in, set_src);
6998
6999 if (REG_P (loc))
7000 var_reg_delete_and_set (out, loc, false, src_status, set_src);
7001 else if (MEM_P (loc))
7002 var_mem_delete_and_set (out, loc, false, src_status, set_src);
7003 }
7004 break;
7005
7006 case MO_USE_NO_VAR:
7007 {
7008 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
7009
7010 if (REG_P (loc))
7011 var_reg_delete (out, loc, false);
7012 else if (MEM_P (loc))
7013 var_mem_delete (out, loc, false);
7014 }
7015 break;
7016
7017 case MO_CLOBBER:
7018 {
7019 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
7020
7021 if (REG_P (loc))
7022 var_reg_delete (out, loc, true);
7023 else if (MEM_P (loc))
7024 var_mem_delete (out, loc, true);
7025 }
7026 break;
7027
7028 case MO_ADJUST:
7029 out->stack_adjust += mo->u.adjust;
7030 break;
7031 }
7032 }
7033
7034 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
7035 {
7036 delete local_get_addr_cache;
7037 local_get_addr_cache = NULL;
7038
7039 dataflow_set_equiv_regs (out);
7040 shared_hash_htab (out->vars)
7041 ->traverse <dataflow_set *, canonicalize_values_mark> (out);
7042 shared_hash_htab (out->vars)
7043 ->traverse <dataflow_set *, canonicalize_values_star> (out);
7044 if (flag_checking)
7045 shared_hash_htab (out->vars)
7046 ->traverse <dataflow_set *, canonicalize_loc_order_check> (out);
7047 }
7048 changed = dataflow_set_different (&old_out, out);
7049 dataflow_set_destroy (&old_out);
7050 return changed;
7051 }
7052
7053 /* Find the locations of variables in the whole function. */
7054
7055 static bool
7056 vt_find_locations (void)
7057 {
7058 bb_heap_t *worklist = new bb_heap_t (LONG_MIN);
7059 bb_heap_t *pending = new bb_heap_t (LONG_MIN);
7060 sbitmap in_worklist, in_pending;
7061 basic_block bb;
7062 edge e;
7063 int *bb_order;
7064 int *rc_order;
7065 int i;
7066 int htabsz = 0;
7067 int htabmax = PARAM_VALUE (PARAM_MAX_VARTRACK_SIZE);
7068 bool success = true;
7069
7070 timevar_push (TV_VAR_TRACKING_DATAFLOW);
7071 /* Compute reverse completion order of depth first search of the CFG
7072 so that the data-flow runs faster. */
7073 rc_order = XNEWVEC (int, n_basic_blocks_for_fn (cfun) - NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS);
7074 bb_order = XNEWVEC (int, last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
7075 pre_and_rev_post_order_compute (NULL, rc_order, false);
7076 for (i = 0; i < n_basic_blocks_for_fn (cfun) - NUM_FIXED_BLOCKS; i++)
7077 bb_order[rc_order[i]] = i;
7078 free (rc_order);
7079
7080 auto_sbitmap visited (last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
7081 in_worklist = sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
7082 in_pending = sbitmap_alloc (last_basic_block_for_fn (cfun));
7083 bitmap_clear (in_worklist);
7084
7085 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
7086 pending->insert (bb_order[bb->index], bb);
7087 bitmap_ones (in_pending);
7088
7089 while (success && !pending->empty ())
7090 {
7091 std::swap (worklist, pending);
7092 std::swap (in_worklist, in_pending);
7093
7094 bitmap_clear (visited);
7095
7096 while (!worklist->empty ())
7097 {
7098 bb = worklist->extract_min ();
7099 bitmap_clear_bit (in_worklist, bb->index);
7100 gcc_assert (!bitmap_bit_p (visited, bb->index));
7101 if (!bitmap_bit_p (visited, bb->index))
7102 {
7103 bool changed;
7104 edge_iterator ei;
7105 int oldinsz, oldoutsz;
7106
7107 bitmap_set_bit (visited, bb->index);
7108
7109 if (VTI (bb)->in.vars)
7110 {
7111 htabsz
7112 -= shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->in.vars)->size ()
7113 + shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->out.vars)->size ();
7114 oldinsz = shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->in.vars)->elements ();
7115 oldoutsz
7116 = shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->out.vars)->elements ();
7117 }
7118 else
7119 oldinsz = oldoutsz = 0;
7120
7121 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
7122 {
7123 dataflow_set *in = &VTI (bb)->in, *first_out = NULL;
7124 bool first = true, adjust = false;
7125
7126 /* Calculate the IN set as the intersection of
7127 predecessor OUT sets. */
7128
7129 dataflow_set_clear (in);
7130 dst_can_be_shared = true;
7131
7132 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
7133 if (!VTI (e->src)->flooded)
7134 gcc_assert (bb_order[bb->index]
7135 <= bb_order[e->src->index]);
7136 else if (first)
7137 {
7138 dataflow_set_copy (in, &VTI (e->src)->out);
7139 first_out = &VTI (e->src)->out;
7140 first = false;
7141 }
7142 else
7143 {
7144 dataflow_set_merge (in, &VTI (e->src)->out);
7145 adjust = true;
7146 }
7147
7148 if (adjust)
7149 {
7150 dataflow_post_merge_adjust (in, &VTI (bb)->permp);
7151
7152 if (flag_checking)
7153 /* Merge and merge_adjust should keep entries in
7154 canonical order. */
7155 shared_hash_htab (in->vars)
7156 ->traverse <dataflow_set *,
7157 canonicalize_loc_order_check> (in);
7158
7159 if (dst_can_be_shared)
7160 {
7161 shared_hash_destroy (in->vars);
7162 in->vars = shared_hash_copy (first_out->vars);
7163 }
7164 }
7165
7166 VTI (bb)->flooded = true;
7167 }
7168 else
7169 {
7170 /* Calculate the IN set as union of predecessor OUT sets. */
7171 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb)->in);
7172 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->preds)
7173 dataflow_set_union (&VTI (bb)->in, &VTI (e->src)->out);
7174 }
7175
7176 changed = compute_bb_dataflow (bb);
7177 htabsz += shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->in.vars)->size ()
7178 + shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->out.vars)->size ();
7179
7180 if (htabmax && htabsz > htabmax)
7181 {
7182 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
7183 inform (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (cfun->decl),
7184 "variable tracking size limit exceeded with "
7185 "-fvar-tracking-assignments, retrying without");
7186 else
7187 inform (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (cfun->decl),
7188 "variable tracking size limit exceeded");
7189 success = false;
7190 break;
7191 }
7192
7193 if (changed)
7194 {
7195 FOR_EACH_EDGE (e, ei, bb->succs)
7196 {
7197 if (e->dest == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun))
7198 continue;
7199
7200 if (bitmap_bit_p (visited, e->dest->index))
7201 {
7202 if (!bitmap_bit_p (in_pending, e->dest->index))
7203 {
7204 /* Send E->DEST to next round. */
7205 bitmap_set_bit (in_pending, e->dest->index);
7206 pending->insert (bb_order[e->dest->index],
7207 e->dest);
7208 }
7209 }
7210 else if (!bitmap_bit_p (in_worklist, e->dest->index))
7211 {
7212 /* Add E->DEST to current round. */
7213 bitmap_set_bit (in_worklist, e->dest->index);
7214 worklist->insert (bb_order[e->dest->index],
7215 e->dest);
7216 }
7217 }
7218 }
7219
7220 if (dump_file)
7221 fprintf (dump_file,
7222 "BB %i: in %i (was %i), out %i (was %i), rem %i + %i, tsz %i\n",
7223 bb->index,
7224 (int)shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->in.vars)->size (),
7225 oldinsz,
7226 (int)shared_hash_htab (VTI (bb)->out.vars)->size (),
7227 oldoutsz,
7228 (int)worklist->nodes (), (int)pending->nodes (),
7229 htabsz);
7230
7231 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
7232 {
7233 fprintf (dump_file, "BB %i IN:\n", bb->index);
7234 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb)->in);
7235 fprintf (dump_file, "BB %i OUT:\n", bb->index);
7236 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb)->out);
7237 }
7238 }
7239 }
7240 }
7241
7242 if (success && MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
7243 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
7244 gcc_assert (VTI (bb)->flooded);
7245
7246 free (bb_order);
7247 delete worklist;
7248 delete pending;
7249 sbitmap_free (in_worklist);
7250 sbitmap_free (in_pending);
7251
7252 timevar_pop (TV_VAR_TRACKING_DATAFLOW);
7253 return success;
7254 }
7255
7256 /* Print the content of the LIST to dump file. */
7257
7258 static void
7259 dump_attrs_list (attrs *list)
7260 {
7261 for (; list; list = list->next)
7262 {
7263 if (dv_is_decl_p (list->dv))
7264 print_mem_expr (dump_file, dv_as_decl (list->dv));
7265 else
7266 print_rtl_single (dump_file, dv_as_value (list->dv));
7267 fprintf (dump_file, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, list->offset);
7268 }
7269 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7270 }
7271
7272 /* Print the information about variable *SLOT to dump file. */
7273
7274 int
7275 dump_var_tracking_slot (variable **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7276 {
7277 variable *var = *slot;
7278
7279 dump_var (var);
7280
7281 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
7282 return 1;
7283 }
7284
7285 /* Print the information about variable VAR to dump file. */
7286
7287 static void
7288 dump_var (variable *var)
7289 {
7290 int i;
7291 location_chain *node;
7292
7293 if (dv_is_decl_p (var->dv))
7294 {
7295 const_tree decl = dv_as_decl (var->dv);
7296
7297 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
7298 {
7299 fprintf (dump_file, " name: %s",
7300 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl)));
7301 if (dump_flags & TDF_UID)
7302 fprintf (dump_file, "D.%u", DECL_UID (decl));
7303 }
7304 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == DEBUG_EXPR_DECL)
7305 fprintf (dump_file, " name: D#%u", DEBUG_TEMP_UID (decl));
7306 else
7307 fprintf (dump_file, " name: D.%u", DECL_UID (decl));
7308 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7309 }
7310 else
7311 {
7312 fputc (' ', dump_file);
7313 print_rtl_single (dump_file, dv_as_value (var->dv));
7314 }
7315
7316 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
7317 {
7318 fprintf (dump_file, " offset %ld\n",
7319 (long)(var->onepart ? 0 : VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, i)));
7320 for (node = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; node; node = node->next)
7321 {
7322 fprintf (dump_file, " ");
7323 if (node->init == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
7324 fprintf (dump_file, "[uninit]");
7325 print_rtl_single (dump_file, node->loc);
7326 }
7327 }
7328 }
7329
7330 /* Print the information about variables from hash table VARS to dump file. */
7331
7332 static void
7333 dump_vars (variable_table_type *vars)
7334 {
7335 if (vars->elements () > 0)
7336 {
7337 fprintf (dump_file, "Variables:\n");
7338 vars->traverse <void *, dump_var_tracking_slot> (NULL);
7339 }
7340 }
7341
7342 /* Print the dataflow set SET to dump file. */
7343
7344 static void
7345 dump_dataflow_set (dataflow_set *set)
7346 {
7347 int i;
7348
7349 fprintf (dump_file, "Stack adjustment: " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC "\n",
7350 set->stack_adjust);
7351 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
7352 {
7353 if (set->regs[i])
7354 {
7355 fprintf (dump_file, "Reg %d:", i);
7356 dump_attrs_list (set->regs[i]);
7357 }
7358 }
7359 dump_vars (shared_hash_htab (set->vars));
7360 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
7361 }
7362
7363 /* Print the IN and OUT sets for each basic block to dump file. */
7364
7365 static void
7366 dump_dataflow_sets (void)
7367 {
7368 basic_block bb;
7369
7370 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
7371 {
7372 fprintf (dump_file, "\nBasic block %d:\n", bb->index);
7373 fprintf (dump_file, "IN:\n");
7374 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb)->in);
7375 fprintf (dump_file, "OUT:\n");
7376 dump_dataflow_set (&VTI (bb)->out);
7377 }
7378 }
7379
7380 /* Return the variable for DV in dropped_values, inserting one if
7381 requested with INSERT. */
7382
7383 static inline variable *
7384 variable_from_dropped (decl_or_value dv, enum insert_option insert)
7385 {
7386 variable **slot;
7387 variable *empty_var;
7388 onepart_enum onepart;
7389
7390 slot = dropped_values->find_slot_with_hash (dv, dv_htab_hash (dv), insert);
7391
7392 if (!slot)
7393 return NULL;
7394
7395 if (*slot)
7396 return *slot;
7397
7398 gcc_checking_assert (insert == INSERT);
7399
7400 onepart = dv_onepart_p (dv);
7401
7402 gcc_checking_assert (onepart == ONEPART_VALUE || onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR);
7403
7404 empty_var = onepart_pool_allocate (onepart);
7405 empty_var->dv = dv;
7406 empty_var->refcount = 1;
7407 empty_var->n_var_parts = 0;
7408 empty_var->onepart = onepart;
7409 empty_var->in_changed_variables = false;
7410 empty_var->var_part[0].loc_chain = NULL;
7411 empty_var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
7412 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var) = NULL;
7413 set_dv_changed (dv, true);
7414
7415 *slot = empty_var;
7416
7417 return empty_var;
7418 }
7419
7420 /* Recover the one-part aux from dropped_values. */
7421
7422 static struct onepart_aux *
7423 recover_dropped_1paux (variable *var)
7424 {
7425 variable *dvar;
7426
7427 gcc_checking_assert (var->onepart);
7428
7429 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
7430 return VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var);
7431
7432 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_VDECL)
7433 return NULL;
7434
7435 dvar = variable_from_dropped (var->dv, NO_INSERT);
7436
7437 if (!dvar)
7438 return NULL;
7439
7440 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar);
7441 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (dvar) = NULL;
7442
7443 return VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var);
7444 }
7445
7446 /* Add variable VAR to the hash table of changed variables and
7447 if it has no locations delete it from SET's hash table. */
7448
7449 static void
7450 variable_was_changed (variable *var, dataflow_set *set)
7451 {
7452 hashval_t hash = dv_htab_hash (var->dv);
7453
7454 if (emit_notes)
7455 {
7456 variable **slot;
7457
7458 /* Remember this decl or VALUE has been added to changed_variables. */
7459 set_dv_changed (var->dv, true);
7460
7461 slot = changed_variables->find_slot_with_hash (var->dv, hash, INSERT);
7462
7463 if (*slot)
7464 {
7465 variable *old_var = *slot;
7466 gcc_assert (old_var->in_changed_variables);
7467 old_var->in_changed_variables = false;
7468 if (var != old_var && var->onepart)
7469 {
7470 /* Restore the auxiliary info from an empty variable
7471 previously created for changed_variables, so it is
7472 not lost. */
7473 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var));
7474 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var);
7475 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var) = NULL;
7476 }
7477 variable_htab_free (*slot);
7478 }
7479
7480 if (set && var->n_var_parts == 0)
7481 {
7482 onepart_enum onepart = var->onepart;
7483 variable *empty_var = NULL;
7484 variable **dslot = NULL;
7485
7486 if (onepart == ONEPART_VALUE || onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR)
7487 {
7488 dslot = dropped_values->find_slot_with_hash (var->dv,
7489 dv_htab_hash (var->dv),
7490 INSERT);
7491 empty_var = *dslot;
7492
7493 if (empty_var)
7494 {
7495 gcc_checking_assert (!empty_var->in_changed_variables);
7496 if (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
7497 {
7498 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var);
7499 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var) = NULL;
7500 }
7501 else
7502 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var));
7503 }
7504 }
7505
7506 if (!empty_var)
7507 {
7508 empty_var = onepart_pool_allocate (onepart);
7509 empty_var->dv = var->dv;
7510 empty_var->refcount = 1;
7511 empty_var->n_var_parts = 0;
7512 empty_var->onepart = onepart;
7513 if (dslot)
7514 {
7515 empty_var->refcount++;
7516 *dslot = empty_var;
7517 }
7518 }
7519 else
7520 empty_var->refcount++;
7521 empty_var->in_changed_variables = true;
7522 *slot = empty_var;
7523 if (onepart)
7524 {
7525 empty_var->var_part[0].loc_chain = NULL;
7526 empty_var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
7527 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var);
7528 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = NULL;
7529 }
7530 goto drop_var;
7531 }
7532 else
7533 {
7534 if (var->onepart && !VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
7535 recover_dropped_1paux (var);
7536 var->refcount++;
7537 var->in_changed_variables = true;
7538 *slot = var;
7539 }
7540 }
7541 else
7542 {
7543 gcc_assert (set);
7544 if (var->n_var_parts == 0)
7545 {
7546 variable **slot;
7547
7548 drop_var:
7549 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, var->dv);
7550 if (slot)
7551 {
7552 if (shared_hash_shared (set->vars))
7553 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set->vars, var->dv,
7554 NO_INSERT);
7555 shared_hash_htab (set->vars)->clear_slot (slot);
7556 }
7557 }
7558 }
7559 }
7560
7561 /* Look for the index in VAR->var_part corresponding to OFFSET.
7562 Return -1 if not found. If INSERTION_POINT is non-NULL, the
7563 referenced int will be set to the index that the part has or should
7564 have, if it should be inserted. */
7565
7566 static inline int
7567 find_variable_location_part (variable *var, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
7568 int *insertion_point)
7569 {
7570 int pos, low, high;
7571
7572 if (var->onepart)
7573 {
7574 if (offset != 0)
7575 return -1;
7576
7577 if (insertion_point)
7578 *insertion_point = 0;
7579
7580 return var->n_var_parts - 1;
7581 }
7582
7583 /* Find the location part. */
7584 low = 0;
7585 high = var->n_var_parts;
7586 while (low != high)
7587 {
7588 pos = (low + high) / 2;
7589 if (VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, pos) < offset)
7590 low = pos + 1;
7591 else
7592 high = pos;
7593 }
7594 pos = low;
7595
7596 if (insertion_point)
7597 *insertion_point = pos;
7598
7599 if (pos < var->n_var_parts && VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, pos) == offset)
7600 return pos;
7601
7602 return -1;
7603 }
7604
7605 static variable **
7606 set_slot_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, variable **slot,
7607 decl_or_value dv, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
7608 enum var_init_status initialized, rtx set_src)
7609 {
7610 int pos;
7611 location_chain *node, *next;
7612 location_chain **nextp;
7613 variable *var;
7614 onepart_enum onepart;
7615
7616 var = *slot;
7617
7618 if (var)
7619 onepart = var->onepart;
7620 else
7621 onepart = dv_onepart_p (dv);
7622
7623 gcc_checking_assert (offset == 0 || !onepart);
7624 gcc_checking_assert (loc != dv_as_opaque (dv));
7625
7626 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
7627 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
7628
7629 if (!var)
7630 {
7631 /* Create new variable information. */
7632 var = onepart_pool_allocate (onepart);
7633 var->dv = dv;
7634 var->refcount = 1;
7635 var->n_var_parts = 1;
7636 var->onepart = onepart;
7637 var->in_changed_variables = false;
7638 if (var->onepart)
7639 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = NULL;
7640 else
7641 VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, 0) = offset;
7642 var->var_part[0].loc_chain = NULL;
7643 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
7644 *slot = var;
7645 pos = 0;
7646 nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain;
7647 }
7648 else if (onepart)
7649 {
7650 int r = -1, c = 0;
7651
7652 gcc_assert (dv_as_opaque (var->dv) == dv_as_opaque (dv));
7653
7654 pos = 0;
7655
7656 if (GET_CODE (loc) == VALUE)
7657 {
7658 for (nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; (node = *nextp);
7659 nextp = &node->next)
7660 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == VALUE)
7661 {
7662 if (node->loc == loc)
7663 {
7664 r = 0;
7665 break;
7666 }
7667 if (canon_value_cmp (node->loc, loc))
7668 c++;
7669 else
7670 {
7671 r = 1;
7672 break;
7673 }
7674 }
7675 else if (REG_P (node->loc) || MEM_P (node->loc))
7676 c++;
7677 else
7678 {
7679 r = 1;
7680 break;
7681 }
7682 }
7683 else if (REG_P (loc))
7684 {
7685 for (nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; (node = *nextp);
7686 nextp = &node->next)
7687 if (REG_P (node->loc))
7688 {
7689 if (REGNO (node->loc) < REGNO (loc))
7690 c++;
7691 else
7692 {
7693 if (REGNO (node->loc) == REGNO (loc))
7694 r = 0;
7695 else
7696 r = 1;
7697 break;
7698 }
7699 }
7700 else
7701 {
7702 r = 1;
7703 break;
7704 }
7705 }
7706 else if (MEM_P (loc))
7707 {
7708 for (nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; (node = *nextp);
7709 nextp = &node->next)
7710 if (REG_P (node->loc))
7711 c++;
7712 else if (MEM_P (node->loc))
7713 {
7714 if ((r = loc_cmp (XEXP (node->loc, 0), XEXP (loc, 0))) >= 0)
7715 break;
7716 else
7717 c++;
7718 }
7719 else
7720 {
7721 r = 1;
7722 break;
7723 }
7724 }
7725 else
7726 for (nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; (node = *nextp);
7727 nextp = &node->next)
7728 if ((r = loc_cmp (node->loc, loc)) >= 0)
7729 break;
7730 else
7731 c++;
7732
7733 if (r == 0)
7734 return slot;
7735
7736 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
7737 {
7738 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, initialized);
7739 var = *slot;
7740 for (nextp = &var->var_part[0].loc_chain; c;
7741 nextp = &(*nextp)->next)
7742 c--;
7743 gcc_assert ((!node && !*nextp) || node->loc == (*nextp)->loc);
7744 }
7745 }
7746 else
7747 {
7748 int inspos = 0;
7749
7750 gcc_assert (dv_as_decl (var->dv) == dv_as_decl (dv));
7751
7752 pos = find_variable_location_part (var, offset, &inspos);
7753
7754 if (pos >= 0)
7755 {
7756 node = var->var_part[pos].loc_chain;
7757
7758 if (node
7759 && ((REG_P (node->loc) && REG_P (loc)
7760 && REGNO (node->loc) == REGNO (loc))
7761 || rtx_equal_p (node->loc, loc)))
7762 {
7763 /* LOC is in the beginning of the chain so we have nothing
7764 to do. */
7765 if (node->init < initialized)
7766 node->init = initialized;
7767 if (set_src != NULL)
7768 node->set_src = set_src;
7769
7770 return slot;
7771 }
7772 else
7773 {
7774 /* We have to make a copy of a shared variable. */
7775 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
7776 {
7777 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, initialized);
7778 var = *slot;
7779 }
7780 }
7781 }
7782 else
7783 {
7784 /* We have not found the location part, new one will be created. */
7785
7786 /* We have to make a copy of the shared variable. */
7787 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
7788 {
7789 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var, initialized);
7790 var = *slot;
7791 }
7792
7793 /* We track only variables whose size is <= MAX_VAR_PARTS bytes
7794 thus there are at most MAX_VAR_PARTS different offsets. */
7795 gcc_assert (var->n_var_parts < MAX_VAR_PARTS
7796 && (!var->n_var_parts || !onepart));
7797
7798 /* We have to move the elements of array starting at index
7799 inspos to the next position. */
7800 for (pos = var->n_var_parts; pos > inspos; pos--)
7801 var->var_part[pos] = var->var_part[pos - 1];
7802
7803 var->n_var_parts++;
7804 gcc_checking_assert (!onepart);
7805 VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, pos) = offset;
7806 var->var_part[pos].loc_chain = NULL;
7807 var->var_part[pos].cur_loc = NULL;
7808 }
7809
7810 /* Delete the location from the list. */
7811 nextp = &var->var_part[pos].loc_chain;
7812 for (node = var->var_part[pos].loc_chain; node; node = next)
7813 {
7814 next = node->next;
7815 if ((REG_P (node->loc) && REG_P (loc)
7816 && REGNO (node->loc) == REGNO (loc))
7817 || rtx_equal_p (node->loc, loc))
7818 {
7819 /* Save these values, to assign to the new node, before
7820 deleting this one. */
7821 if (node->init > initialized)
7822 initialized = node->init;
7823 if (node->set_src != NULL && set_src == NULL)
7824 set_src = node->set_src;
7825 if (var->var_part[pos].cur_loc == node->loc)
7826 var->var_part[pos].cur_loc = NULL;
7827 delete node;
7828 *nextp = next;
7829 break;
7830 }
7831 else
7832 nextp = &node->next;
7833 }
7834
7835 nextp = &var->var_part[pos].loc_chain;
7836 }
7837
7838 /* Add the location to the beginning. */
7839 node = new location_chain;
7840 node->loc = loc;
7841 node->init = initialized;
7842 node->set_src = set_src;
7843 node->next = *nextp;
7844 *nextp = node;
7845
7846 /* If no location was emitted do so. */
7847 if (var->var_part[pos].cur_loc == NULL)
7848 variable_was_changed (var, set);
7849
7850 return slot;
7851 }
7852
7853 /* Set the part of variable's location in the dataflow set SET. The
7854 variable part is specified by variable's declaration in DV and
7855 offset OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. IOPT should be
7856 NO_INSERT if the variable is known to be in SET already and the
7857 variable hash table must not be resized, and INSERT otherwise. */
7858
7859 static void
7860 set_variable_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc,
7861 decl_or_value dv, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
7862 enum var_init_status initialized, rtx set_src,
7863 enum insert_option iopt)
7864 {
7865 variable **slot;
7866
7867 if (iopt == NO_INSERT)
7868 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, dv);
7869 else
7870 {
7871 slot = shared_hash_find_slot (set->vars, dv);
7872 if (!slot)
7873 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_unshare (&set->vars, dv, iopt);
7874 }
7875 set_slot_part (set, loc, slot, dv, offset, initialized, set_src);
7876 }
7877
7878 /* Remove all recorded register locations for the given variable part
7879 from dataflow set SET, except for those that are identical to loc.
7880 The variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value
7881 DV and offset OFFSET. */
7882
7883 static variable **
7884 clobber_slot_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, variable **slot,
7885 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, rtx set_src)
7886 {
7887 variable *var = *slot;
7888 int pos = find_variable_location_part (var, offset, NULL);
7889
7890 if (pos >= 0)
7891 {
7892 location_chain *node, *next;
7893
7894 /* Remove the register locations from the dataflow set. */
7895 next = var->var_part[pos].loc_chain;
7896 for (node = next; node; node = next)
7897 {
7898 next = node->next;
7899 if (node->loc != loc
7900 && (!flag_var_tracking_uninit
7901 || !set_src
7902 || MEM_P (set_src)
7903 || !rtx_equal_p (set_src, node->set_src)))
7904 {
7905 if (REG_P (node->loc))
7906 {
7907 attrs *anode, *anext;
7908 attrs **anextp;
7909
7910 /* Remove the variable part from the register's
7911 list, but preserve any other variable parts
7912 that might be regarded as live in that same
7913 register. */
7914 anextp = &set->regs[REGNO (node->loc)];
7915 for (anode = *anextp; anode; anode = anext)
7916 {
7917 anext = anode->next;
7918 if (dv_as_opaque (anode->dv) == dv_as_opaque (var->dv)
7919 && anode->offset == offset)
7920 {
7921 delete anode;
7922 *anextp = anext;
7923 }
7924 else
7925 anextp = &anode->next;
7926 }
7927 }
7928
7929 slot = delete_slot_part (set, node->loc, slot, offset);
7930 }
7931 }
7932 }
7933
7934 return slot;
7935 }
7936
7937 /* Remove all recorded register locations for the given variable part
7938 from dataflow set SET, except for those that are identical to loc.
7939 The variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value
7940 DV and offset OFFSET. */
7941
7942 static void
7943 clobber_variable_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, decl_or_value dv,
7944 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, rtx set_src)
7945 {
7946 variable **slot;
7947
7948 if (!dv_as_opaque (dv)
7949 || (!dv_is_value_p (dv) && ! DECL_P (dv_as_decl (dv))))
7950 return;
7951
7952 slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, dv);
7953 if (!slot)
7954 return;
7955
7956 clobber_slot_part (set, loc, slot, offset, set_src);
7957 }
7958
7959 /* Delete the part of variable's location from dataflow set SET. The
7960 variable part is specified by its SET->vars slot SLOT and offset
7961 OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. */
7962
7963 static variable **
7964 delete_slot_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, variable **slot,
7965 HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
7966 {
7967 variable *var = *slot;
7968 int pos = find_variable_location_part (var, offset, NULL);
7969
7970 if (pos >= 0)
7971 {
7972 location_chain *node, *next;
7973 location_chain **nextp;
7974 bool changed;
7975 rtx cur_loc;
7976
7977 if (shared_var_p (var, set->vars))
7978 {
7979 /* If the variable contains the location part we have to
7980 make a copy of the variable. */
7981 for (node = var->var_part[pos].loc_chain; node;
7982 node = node->next)
7983 {
7984 if ((REG_P (node->loc) && REG_P (loc)
7985 && REGNO (node->loc) == REGNO (loc))
7986 || rtx_equal_p (node->loc, loc))
7987 {
7988 slot = unshare_variable (set, slot, var,
7989 VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNKNOWN);
7990 var = *slot;
7991 break;
7992 }
7993 }
7994 }
7995
7996 if (pos == 0 && var->onepart && VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
7997 cur_loc = VAR_LOC_FROM (var);
7998 else
7999 cur_loc = var->var_part[pos].cur_loc;
8000
8001 /* Delete the location part. */
8002 changed = false;
8003 nextp = &var->var_part[pos].loc_chain;
8004 for (node = *nextp; node; node = next)
8005 {
8006 next = node->next;
8007 if ((REG_P (node->loc) && REG_P (loc)
8008 && REGNO (node->loc) == REGNO (loc))
8009 || rtx_equal_p (node->loc, loc))
8010 {
8011 /* If we have deleted the location which was last emitted
8012 we have to emit new location so add the variable to set
8013 of changed variables. */
8014 if (cur_loc == node->loc)
8015 {
8016 changed = true;
8017 var->var_part[pos].cur_loc = NULL;
8018 if (pos == 0 && var->onepart && VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
8019 VAR_LOC_FROM (var) = NULL;
8020 }
8021 delete node;
8022 *nextp = next;
8023 break;
8024 }
8025 else
8026 nextp = &node->next;
8027 }
8028
8029 if (var->var_part[pos].loc_chain == NULL)
8030 {
8031 changed = true;
8032 var->n_var_parts--;
8033 while (pos < var->n_var_parts)
8034 {
8035 var->var_part[pos] = var->var_part[pos + 1];
8036 pos++;
8037 }
8038 }
8039 if (changed)
8040 variable_was_changed (var, set);
8041 }
8042
8043 return slot;
8044 }
8045
8046 /* Delete the part of variable's location from dataflow set SET. The
8047 variable part is specified by variable's declaration or value DV
8048 and offset OFFSET and the part's location by LOC. */
8049
8050 static void
8051 delete_variable_part (dataflow_set *set, rtx loc, decl_or_value dv,
8052 HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
8053 {
8054 variable **slot = shared_hash_find_slot_noinsert (set->vars, dv);
8055 if (!slot)
8056 return;
8057
8058 delete_slot_part (set, loc, slot, offset);
8059 }
8060
8061
8062 /* Structure for passing some other parameters to function
8063 vt_expand_loc_callback. */
8064 struct expand_loc_callback_data
8065 {
8066 /* The variables and values active at this point. */
8067 variable_table_type *vars;
8068
8069 /* Stack of values and debug_exprs under expansion, and their
8070 children. */
8071 auto_vec<rtx, 4> expanding;
8072
8073 /* Stack of values and debug_exprs whose expansion hit recursion
8074 cycles. They will have VALUE_RECURSED_INTO marked when added to
8075 this list. This flag will be cleared if any of its dependencies
8076 resolves to a valid location. So, if the flag remains set at the
8077 end of the search, we know no valid location for this one can
8078 possibly exist. */
8079 auto_vec<rtx, 4> pending;
8080
8081 /* The maximum depth among the sub-expressions under expansion.
8082 Zero indicates no expansion so far. */
8083 expand_depth depth;
8084 };
8085
8086 /* Allocate the one-part auxiliary data structure for VAR, with enough
8087 room for COUNT dependencies. */
8088
8089 static void
8090 loc_exp_dep_alloc (variable *var, int count)
8091 {
8092 size_t allocsize;
8093
8094 gcc_checking_assert (var->onepart);
8095
8096 /* We can be called with COUNT == 0 to allocate the data structure
8097 without any dependencies, e.g. for the backlinks only. However,
8098 if we are specifying a COUNT, then the dependency list must have
8099 been emptied before. It would be possible to adjust pointers or
8100 force it empty here, but this is better done at an earlier point
8101 in the algorithm, so we instead leave an assertion to catch
8102 errors. */
8103 gcc_checking_assert (!count
8104 || VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var) == NULL
8105 || VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)->is_empty ());
8106
8107 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) && VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)->space (count))
8108 return;
8109
8110 allocsize = offsetof (struct onepart_aux, deps)
8111 + vec<loc_exp_dep, va_heap, vl_embed>::embedded_size (count);
8112
8113 if (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var))
8114 {
8115 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = XRESIZEVAR (struct onepart_aux,
8116 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var), allocsize);
8117 /* If the reallocation moves the onepaux structure, the
8118 back-pointer to BACKLINKS in the first list member will still
8119 point to its old location. Adjust it. */
8120 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var))
8121 VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var)->pprev = VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (var);
8122 }
8123 else
8124 {
8125 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var) = XNEWVAR (struct onepart_aux, allocsize);
8126 *VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (var) = NULL;
8127 VAR_LOC_FROM (var) = NULL;
8128 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var).complexity = 0;
8129 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var).entryvals = 0;
8130 }
8131 VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)->embedded_init (count);
8132 }
8133
8134 /* Remove all entries from the vector of active dependencies of VAR,
8135 removing them from the back-links lists too. */
8136
8137 static void
8138 loc_exp_dep_clear (variable *var)
8139 {
8140 while (VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var) && !VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)->is_empty ())
8141 {
8142 loc_exp_dep *led = &VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)->last ();
8143 if (led->next)
8144 led->next->pprev = led->pprev;
8145 if (led->pprev)
8146 *led->pprev = led->next;
8147 VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)->pop ();
8148 }
8149 }
8150
8151 /* Insert an active dependency from VAR on X to the vector of
8152 dependencies, and add the corresponding back-link to X's list of
8153 back-links in VARS. */
8154
8155 static void
8156 loc_exp_insert_dep (variable *var, rtx x, variable_table_type *vars)
8157 {
8158 decl_or_value dv;
8159 variable *xvar;
8160 loc_exp_dep *led;
8161
8162 dv = dv_from_rtx (x);
8163
8164 /* ??? Build a vector of variables parallel to EXPANDING, to avoid
8165 an additional look up? */
8166 xvar = vars->find_with_hash (dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
8167
8168 if (!xvar)
8169 {
8170 xvar = variable_from_dropped (dv, NO_INSERT);
8171 gcc_checking_assert (xvar);
8172 }
8173
8174 /* No point in adding the same backlink more than once. This may
8175 arise if say the same value appears in two complex expressions in
8176 the same loc_list, or even more than once in a single
8177 expression. */
8178 if (VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (xvar) && VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (xvar)->dv == var->dv)
8179 return;
8180
8181 if (var->onepart == NOT_ONEPART)
8182 led = new loc_exp_dep;
8183 else
8184 {
8185 loc_exp_dep empty;
8186 memset (&empty, 0, sizeof (empty));
8187 VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)->quick_push (empty);
8188 led = &VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)->last ();
8189 }
8190 led->dv = var->dv;
8191 led->value = x;
8192
8193 loc_exp_dep_alloc (xvar, 0);
8194 led->pprev = VAR_LOC_DEP_LSTP (xvar);
8195 led->next = *led->pprev;
8196 if (led->next)
8197 led->next->pprev = &led->next;
8198 *led->pprev = led;
8199 }
8200
8201 /* Create active dependencies of VAR on COUNT values starting at
8202 VALUE, and corresponding back-links to the entries in VARS. Return
8203 true if we found any pending-recursion results. */
8204
8205 static bool
8206 loc_exp_dep_set (variable *var, rtx result, rtx *value, int count,
8207 variable_table_type *vars)
8208 {
8209 bool pending_recursion = false;
8210
8211 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var) == NULL
8212 || VAR_LOC_DEP_VEC (var)->is_empty ());
8213
8214 /* Set up all dependencies from last_child (as set up at the end of
8215 the loop above) to the end. */
8216 loc_exp_dep_alloc (var, count);
8217
8218 while (count--)
8219 {
8220 rtx x = *value++;
8221
8222 if (!pending_recursion)
8223 pending_recursion = !result && VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x);
8224
8225 loc_exp_insert_dep (var, x, vars);
8226 }
8227
8228 return pending_recursion;
8229 }
8230
8231 /* Notify the back-links of IVAR that are pending recursion that we
8232 have found a non-NIL value for it, so they are cleared for another
8233 attempt to compute a current location. */
8234
8235 static void
8236 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (variable *ivar, variable_table_type *vars)
8237 {
8238 loc_exp_dep *led, *next;
8239
8240 for (led = VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (ivar); led; led = next)
8241 {
8242 decl_or_value dv = led->dv;
8243 variable *var;
8244
8245 next = led->next;
8246
8247 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
8248 {
8249 rtx value = dv_as_value (dv);
8250
8251 /* If we have already resolved it, leave it alone. */
8252 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (value))
8253 continue;
8254
8255 /* Check that VALUE_RECURSED_INTO, true from the test above,
8256 implies NO_LOC_P. */
8257 gcc_checking_assert (NO_LOC_P (value));
8258
8259 /* We won't notify variables that are being expanded,
8260 because their dependency list is cleared before
8261 recursing. */
8262 NO_LOC_P (value) = false;
8263 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (value) = false;
8264
8265 gcc_checking_assert (dv_changed_p (dv));
8266 }
8267 else
8268 {
8269 gcc_checking_assert (dv_onepart_p (dv) != NOT_ONEPART);
8270 if (!dv_changed_p (dv))
8271 continue;
8272 }
8273
8274 var = vars->find_with_hash (dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
8275
8276 if (!var)
8277 var = variable_from_dropped (dv, NO_INSERT);
8278
8279 if (var)
8280 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (var, vars);
8281
8282 if (next)
8283 next->pprev = led->pprev;
8284 if (led->pprev)
8285 *led->pprev = next;
8286 led->next = NULL;
8287 led->pprev = NULL;
8288 }
8289 }
8290
8291 static rtx vt_expand_loc_callback (rtx x, bitmap regs,
8292 int max_depth, void *data);
8293
8294 /* Return the combined depth, when one sub-expression evaluated to
8295 BEST_DEPTH and the previous known depth was SAVED_DEPTH. */
8296
8297 static inline expand_depth
8298 update_depth (expand_depth saved_depth, expand_depth best_depth)
8299 {
8300 /* If we didn't find anything, stick with what we had. */
8301 if (!best_depth.complexity)
8302 return saved_depth;
8303
8304 /* If we found hadn't found anything, use the depth of the current
8305 expression. Do NOT add one extra level, we want to compute the
8306 maximum depth among sub-expressions. We'll increment it later,
8307 if appropriate. */
8308 if (!saved_depth.complexity)
8309 return best_depth;
8310
8311 /* Combine the entryval count so that regardless of which one we
8312 return, the entryval count is accurate. */
8313 best_depth.entryvals = saved_depth.entryvals
8314 = best_depth.entryvals + saved_depth.entryvals;
8315
8316 if (saved_depth.complexity < best_depth.complexity)
8317 return best_depth;
8318 else
8319 return saved_depth;
8320 }
8321
8322 /* Expand VAR to a location RTX, updating its cur_loc. Use REGS and
8323 DATA for cselib expand callback. If PENDRECP is given, indicate in
8324 it whether any sub-expression couldn't be fully evaluated because
8325 it is pending recursion resolution. */
8326
8327 static inline rtx
8328 vt_expand_var_loc_chain (variable *var, bitmap regs, void *data,
8329 bool *pendrecp)
8330 {
8331 struct expand_loc_callback_data *elcd
8332 = (struct expand_loc_callback_data *) data;
8333 location_chain *loc, *next;
8334 rtx result = NULL;
8335 int first_child, result_first_child, last_child;
8336 bool pending_recursion;
8337 rtx loc_from = NULL;
8338 struct elt_loc_list *cloc = NULL;
8339 expand_depth depth = { 0, 0 }, saved_depth = elcd->depth;
8340 int wanted_entryvals, found_entryvals = 0;
8341
8342 /* Clear all backlinks pointing at this, so that we're not notified
8343 while we're active. */
8344 loc_exp_dep_clear (var);
8345
8346 retry:
8347 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_VALUE)
8348 {
8349 cselib_val *val = CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (var->dv));
8350
8351 gcc_checking_assert (cselib_preserved_value_p (val));
8352
8353 cloc = val->locs;
8354 }
8355
8356 first_child = result_first_child = last_child
8357 = elcd->expanding.length ();
8358
8359 wanted_entryvals = found_entryvals;
8360
8361 /* Attempt to expand each available location in turn. */
8362 for (next = loc = var->n_var_parts ? var->var_part[0].loc_chain : NULL;
8363 loc || cloc; loc = next)
8364 {
8365 result_first_child = last_child;
8366
8367 if (!loc)
8368 {
8369 loc_from = cloc->loc;
8370 next = loc;
8371 cloc = cloc->next;
8372 if (unsuitable_loc (loc_from))
8373 continue;
8374 }
8375 else
8376 {
8377 loc_from = loc->loc;
8378 next = loc->next;
8379 }
8380
8381 gcc_checking_assert (!unsuitable_loc (loc_from));
8382
8383 elcd->depth.complexity = elcd->depth.entryvals = 0;
8384 result = cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (loc_from, regs, EXPR_DEPTH,
8385 vt_expand_loc_callback, data);
8386 last_child = elcd->expanding.length ();
8387
8388 if (result)
8389 {
8390 depth = elcd->depth;
8391
8392 gcc_checking_assert (depth.complexity
8393 || result_first_child == last_child);
8394
8395 if (last_child - result_first_child != 1)
8396 {
8397 if (!depth.complexity && GET_CODE (result) == ENTRY_VALUE)
8398 depth.entryvals++;
8399 depth.complexity++;
8400 }
8401
8402 if (depth.complexity <= EXPR_USE_DEPTH)
8403 {
8404 if (depth.entryvals <= wanted_entryvals)
8405 break;
8406 else if (!found_entryvals || depth.entryvals < found_entryvals)
8407 found_entryvals = depth.entryvals;
8408 }
8409
8410 result = NULL;
8411 }
8412
8413 /* Set it up in case we leave the loop. */
8414 depth.complexity = depth.entryvals = 0;
8415 loc_from = NULL;
8416 result_first_child = first_child;
8417 }
8418
8419 if (!loc_from && wanted_entryvals < found_entryvals)
8420 {
8421 /* We found entries with ENTRY_VALUEs and skipped them. Since
8422 we could not find any expansions without ENTRY_VALUEs, but we
8423 found at least one with them, go back and get an entry with
8424 the minimum number ENTRY_VALUE count that we found. We could
8425 avoid looping, but since each sub-loc is already resolved,
8426 the re-expansion should be trivial. ??? Should we record all
8427 attempted locs as dependencies, so that we retry the
8428 expansion should any of them change, in the hope it can give
8429 us a new entry without an ENTRY_VALUE? */
8430 elcd->expanding.truncate (first_child);
8431 goto retry;
8432 }
8433
8434 /* Register all encountered dependencies as active. */
8435 pending_recursion = loc_exp_dep_set
8436 (var, result, elcd->expanding.address () + result_first_child,
8437 last_child - result_first_child, elcd->vars);
8438
8439 elcd->expanding.truncate (first_child);
8440
8441 /* Record where the expansion came from. */
8442 gcc_checking_assert (!result || !pending_recursion);
8443 VAR_LOC_FROM (var) = loc_from;
8444 VAR_LOC_DEPTH (var) = depth;
8445
8446 gcc_checking_assert (!depth.complexity == !result);
8447
8448 elcd->depth = update_depth (saved_depth, depth);
8449
8450 /* Indicate whether any of the dependencies are pending recursion
8451 resolution. */
8452 if (pendrecp)
8453 *pendrecp = pending_recursion;
8454
8455 if (!pendrecp || !pending_recursion)
8456 var->var_part[0].cur_loc = result;
8457
8458 return result;
8459 }
8460
8461 /* Callback for cselib_expand_value, that looks for expressions
8462 holding the value in the var-tracking hash tables. Return X for
8463 standard processing, anything else is to be used as-is. */
8464
8465 static rtx
8466 vt_expand_loc_callback (rtx x, bitmap regs,
8467 int max_depth ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8468 void *data)
8469 {
8470 struct expand_loc_callback_data *elcd
8471 = (struct expand_loc_callback_data *) data;
8472 decl_or_value dv;
8473 variable *var;
8474 rtx result, subreg;
8475 bool pending_recursion = false;
8476 bool from_empty = false;
8477
8478 switch (GET_CODE (x))
8479 {
8480 case SUBREG:
8481 subreg = cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (SUBREG_REG (x), regs,
8482 EXPR_DEPTH,
8483 vt_expand_loc_callback, data);
8484
8485 if (!subreg)
8486 return NULL;
8487
8488 result = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (x), subreg,
8489 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)),
8490 SUBREG_BYTE (x));
8491
8492 /* Invalid SUBREGs are ok in debug info. ??? We could try
8493 alternate expansions for the VALUE as well. */
8494 if (!result)
8495 result = gen_rtx_raw_SUBREG (GET_MODE (x), subreg, SUBREG_BYTE (x));
8496
8497 return result;
8498
8499 case DEBUG_EXPR:
8500 case VALUE:
8501 dv = dv_from_rtx (x);
8502 break;
8503
8504 default:
8505 return x;
8506 }
8507
8508 elcd->expanding.safe_push (x);
8509
8510 /* Check that VALUE_RECURSED_INTO implies NO_LOC_P. */
8511 gcc_checking_assert (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x) || NO_LOC_P (x));
8512
8513 if (NO_LOC_P (x))
8514 {
8515 gcc_checking_assert (VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x) || !dv_changed_p (dv));
8516 return NULL;
8517 }
8518
8519 var = elcd->vars->find_with_hash (dv, dv_htab_hash (dv));
8520
8521 if (!var)
8522 {
8523 from_empty = true;
8524 var = variable_from_dropped (dv, INSERT);
8525 }
8526
8527 gcc_checking_assert (var);
8528
8529 if (!dv_changed_p (dv))
8530 {
8531 gcc_checking_assert (!NO_LOC_P (x));
8532 gcc_checking_assert (var->var_part[0].cur_loc);
8533 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var));
8534 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->depth.complexity);
8535
8536 elcd->depth = update_depth (elcd->depth, VAR_LOC_1PAUX (var)->depth);
8537
8538 return var->var_part[0].cur_loc;
8539 }
8540
8541 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x) = true;
8542 /* This is tentative, but it makes some tests simpler. */
8543 NO_LOC_P (x) = true;
8544
8545 gcc_checking_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1 || from_empty);
8546
8547 result = vt_expand_var_loc_chain (var, regs, data, &pending_recursion);
8548
8549 if (pending_recursion)
8550 {
8551 gcc_checking_assert (!result);
8552 elcd->pending.safe_push (x);
8553 }
8554 else
8555 {
8556 NO_LOC_P (x) = !result;
8557 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x) = false;
8558 set_dv_changed (dv, false);
8559
8560 if (result)
8561 notify_dependents_of_resolved_value (var, elcd->vars);
8562 }
8563
8564 return result;
8565 }
8566
8567 /* While expanding variables, we may encounter recursion cycles
8568 because of mutual (possibly indirect) dependencies between two
8569 particular variables (or values), say A and B. If we're trying to
8570 expand A when we get to B, which in turn attempts to expand A, if
8571 we can't find any other expansion for B, we'll add B to this
8572 pending-recursion stack, and tentatively return NULL for its
8573 location. This tentative value will be used for any other
8574 occurrences of B, unless A gets some other location, in which case
8575 it will notify B that it is worth another try at computing a
8576 location for it, and it will use the location computed for A then.
8577 At the end of the expansion, the tentative NULL locations become
8578 final for all members of PENDING that didn't get a notification.
8579 This function performs this finalization of NULL locations. */
8580
8581 static void
8582 resolve_expansions_pending_recursion (vec<rtx, va_heap> *pending)
8583 {
8584 while (!pending->is_empty ())
8585 {
8586 rtx x = pending->pop ();
8587 decl_or_value dv;
8588
8589 if (!VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x))
8590 continue;
8591
8592 gcc_checking_assert (NO_LOC_P (x));
8593 VALUE_RECURSED_INTO (x) = false;
8594 dv = dv_from_rtx (x);
8595 gcc_checking_assert (dv_changed_p (dv));
8596 set_dv_changed (dv, false);
8597 }
8598 }
8599
8600 /* Initialize expand_loc_callback_data D with variable hash table V.
8601 It must be a macro because of alloca (vec stack). */
8602 #define INIT_ELCD(d, v) \
8603 do \
8604 { \
8605 (d).vars = (v); \
8606 (d).depth.complexity = (d).depth.entryvals = 0; \
8607 } \
8608 while (0)
8609 /* Finalize expand_loc_callback_data D, resolved to location L. */
8610 #define FINI_ELCD(d, l) \
8611 do \
8612 { \
8613 resolve_expansions_pending_recursion (&(d).pending); \
8614 (d).pending.release (); \
8615 (d).expanding.release (); \
8616 \
8617 if ((l) && MEM_P (l)) \
8618 (l) = targetm.delegitimize_address (l); \
8619 } \
8620 while (0)
8621
8622 /* Expand VALUEs and DEBUG_EXPRs in LOC to a location, using the
8623 equivalences in VARS, updating their CUR_LOCs in the process. */
8624
8625 static rtx
8626 vt_expand_loc (rtx loc, variable_table_type *vars)
8627 {
8628 struct expand_loc_callback_data data;
8629 rtx result;
8630
8631 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
8632 return loc;
8633
8634 INIT_ELCD (data, vars);
8635
8636 result = cselib_expand_value_rtx_cb (loc, scratch_regs, EXPR_DEPTH,
8637 vt_expand_loc_callback, &data);
8638
8639 FINI_ELCD (data, result);
8640
8641 return result;
8642 }
8643
8644 /* Expand the one-part VARiable to a location, using the equivalences
8645 in VARS, updating their CUR_LOCs in the process. */
8646
8647 static rtx
8648 vt_expand_1pvar (variable *var, variable_table_type *vars)
8649 {
8650 struct expand_loc_callback_data data;
8651 rtx loc;
8652
8653 gcc_checking_assert (var->onepart && var->n_var_parts == 1);
8654
8655 if (!dv_changed_p (var->dv))
8656 return var->var_part[0].cur_loc;
8657
8658 INIT_ELCD (data, vars);
8659
8660 loc = vt_expand_var_loc_chain (var, scratch_regs, &data, NULL);
8661
8662 gcc_checking_assert (data.expanding.is_empty ());
8663
8664 FINI_ELCD (data, loc);
8665
8666 return loc;
8667 }
8668
8669 /* Emit the NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for variable *VARP. DATA contains
8670 additional parameters: WHERE specifies whether the note shall be emitted
8671 before or after instruction INSN. */
8672
8673 int
8674 emit_note_insn_var_location (variable **varp, emit_note_data *data)
8675 {
8676 variable *var = *varp;
8677 rtx_insn *insn = data->insn;
8678 enum emit_note_where where = data->where;
8679 variable_table_type *vars = data->vars;
8680 rtx_note *note;
8681 rtx note_vl;
8682 int i, j, n_var_parts;
8683 bool complete;
8684 enum var_init_status initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED;
8685 HOST_WIDE_INT last_limit;
8686 HOST_WIDE_INT offsets[MAX_VAR_PARTS];
8687 rtx loc[MAX_VAR_PARTS];
8688 tree decl;
8689 location_chain *lc;
8690
8691 gcc_checking_assert (var->onepart == NOT_ONEPART
8692 || var->onepart == ONEPART_VDECL);
8693
8694 decl = dv_as_decl (var->dv);
8695
8696 complete = true;
8697 last_limit = 0;
8698 n_var_parts = 0;
8699 if (!var->onepart)
8700 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
8701 if (var->var_part[i].cur_loc == NULL && var->var_part[i].loc_chain)
8702 var->var_part[i].cur_loc = var->var_part[i].loc_chain->loc;
8703 for (i = 0; i < var->n_var_parts; i++)
8704 {
8705 machine_mode mode, wider_mode;
8706 rtx loc2;
8707 HOST_WIDE_INT offset, size, wider_size;
8708
8709 if (i == 0 && var->onepart)
8710 {
8711 gcc_checking_assert (var->n_var_parts == 1);
8712 offset = 0;
8713 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
8714 loc2 = vt_expand_1pvar (var, vars);
8715 }
8716 else
8717 {
8718 if (last_limit < VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, i))
8719 {
8720 complete = false;
8721 break;
8722 }
8723 else if (last_limit > VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, i))
8724 continue;
8725 offset = VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, i);
8726 loc2 = var->var_part[i].cur_loc;
8727 if (loc2 && GET_CODE (loc2) == MEM
8728 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc2, 0)) == VALUE)
8729 {
8730 rtx depval = XEXP (loc2, 0);
8731
8732 loc2 = vt_expand_loc (loc2, vars);
8733
8734 if (loc2)
8735 loc_exp_insert_dep (var, depval, vars);
8736 }
8737 if (!loc2)
8738 {
8739 complete = false;
8740 continue;
8741 }
8742 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (loc2) != VALUE);
8743 for (lc = var->var_part[i].loc_chain; lc; lc = lc->next)
8744 if (var->var_part[i].cur_loc == lc->loc)
8745 {
8746 initialized = lc->init;
8747 break;
8748 }
8749 gcc_assert (lc);
8750 }
8751
8752 offsets[n_var_parts] = offset;
8753 if (!loc2)
8754 {
8755 complete = false;
8756 continue;
8757 }
8758 loc[n_var_parts] = loc2;
8759 mode = GET_MODE (var->var_part[i].cur_loc);
8760 if (mode == VOIDmode && var->onepart)
8761 mode = DECL_MODE (decl);
8762 /* We ony track subparts of constant-sized objects, since at present
8763 there's no representation for polynomial pieces. */
8764 if (!GET_MODE_SIZE (mode).is_constant (&size))
8765 {
8766 complete = false;
8767 continue;
8768 }
8769 last_limit = offsets[n_var_parts] + size;
8770
8771 /* Attempt to merge adjacent registers or memory. */
8772 for (j = i + 1; j < var->n_var_parts; j++)
8773 if (last_limit <= VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, j))
8774 break;
8775 if (j < var->n_var_parts
8776 && GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode).exists (&wider_mode)
8777 && GET_MODE_SIZE (wider_mode).is_constant (&wider_size)
8778 && var->var_part[j].cur_loc
8779 && mode == GET_MODE (var->var_part[j].cur_loc)
8780 && (REG_P (loc[n_var_parts]) || MEM_P (loc[n_var_parts]))
8781 && last_limit == (var->onepart ? 0 : VAR_PART_OFFSET (var, j))
8782 && (loc2 = vt_expand_loc (var->var_part[j].cur_loc, vars))
8783 && GET_CODE (loc[n_var_parts]) == GET_CODE (loc2))
8784 {
8785 rtx new_loc = NULL;
8786 poly_int64 offset2;
8787
8788 if (REG_P (loc[n_var_parts])
8789 && hard_regno_nregs (REGNO (loc[n_var_parts]), mode) * 2
8790 == hard_regno_nregs (REGNO (loc[n_var_parts]), wider_mode)
8791 && end_hard_regno (mode, REGNO (loc[n_var_parts]))
8792 == REGNO (loc2))
8793 {
8794 if (! WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN && ! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
8795 new_loc = simplify_subreg (wider_mode, loc[n_var_parts],
8796 mode, 0);
8797 else if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
8798 new_loc = simplify_subreg (wider_mode, loc2, mode, 0);
8799 if (new_loc)
8800 {
8801 if (!REG_P (new_loc)
8802 || REGNO (new_loc) != REGNO (loc[n_var_parts]))
8803 new_loc = NULL;
8804 else
8805 REG_ATTRS (new_loc) = REG_ATTRS (loc[n_var_parts]);
8806 }
8807 }
8808 else if (MEM_P (loc[n_var_parts])
8809 && GET_CODE (XEXP (loc2, 0)) == PLUS
8810 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (loc2, 0), 0))
8811 && poly_int_rtx_p (XEXP (XEXP (loc2, 0), 1), &offset2))
8812 {
8813 poly_int64 end1 = size;
8814 rtx base1 = strip_offset_and_add (XEXP (loc[n_var_parts], 0),
8815 &end1);
8816 if (rtx_equal_p (base1, XEXP (XEXP (loc2, 0), 0))
8817 && known_eq (end1, offset2))
8818 new_loc = adjust_address_nv (loc[n_var_parts],
8819 wider_mode, 0);
8820 }
8821
8822 if (new_loc)
8823 {
8824 loc[n_var_parts] = new_loc;
8825 mode = wider_mode;
8826 last_limit = offsets[n_var_parts] + wider_size;
8827 i = j;
8828 }
8829 }
8830 ++n_var_parts;
8831 }
8832 poly_uint64 type_size_unit
8833 = tree_to_poly_uint64 (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
8834 if (maybe_lt (poly_uint64 (last_limit), type_size_unit))
8835 complete = false;
8836
8837 if (! flag_var_tracking_uninit)
8838 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
8839
8840 note_vl = NULL_RTX;
8841 if (!complete)
8842 note_vl = gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode, decl, NULL_RTX, initialized);
8843 else if (n_var_parts == 1)
8844 {
8845 rtx expr_list;
8846
8847 if (offsets[0] || GET_CODE (loc[0]) == PARALLEL)
8848 expr_list = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, loc[0], GEN_INT (offsets[0]));
8849 else
8850 expr_list = loc[0];
8851
8852 note_vl = gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode, decl, expr_list, initialized);
8853 }
8854 else if (n_var_parts)
8855 {
8856 rtx parallel;
8857
8858 for (i = 0; i < n_var_parts; i++)
8859 loc[i]
8860 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, loc[i], GEN_INT (offsets[i]));
8861
8862 parallel = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode,
8863 gen_rtvec_v (n_var_parts, loc));
8864 note_vl = gen_rtx_VAR_LOCATION (VOIDmode, decl,
8865 parallel, initialized);
8866 }
8867
8868 if (where != EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN)
8869 {
8870 note = emit_note_after (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, insn);
8871 if (where == EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN)
8872 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (note) = true;
8873 }
8874 else
8875 {
8876 /* Make sure that the call related notes come first. */
8877 while (NEXT_INSN (insn)
8878 && NOTE_P (insn)
8879 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
8880 && NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (insn))
8881 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
8882 if (NOTE_P (insn)
8883 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION
8884 && NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (insn))
8885 note = emit_note_after (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, insn);
8886 else
8887 note = emit_note_before (NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, insn);
8888 }
8889 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (note) = note_vl;
8890
8891 set_dv_changed (var->dv, false);
8892 gcc_assert (var->in_changed_variables);
8893 var->in_changed_variables = false;
8894 changed_variables->clear_slot (varp);
8895
8896 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
8897 return 1;
8898 }
8899
8900 /* While traversing changed_variables, push onto DATA (a stack of RTX
8901 values) entries that aren't user variables. */
8902
8903 int
8904 var_track_values_to_stack (variable **slot,
8905 vec<rtx, va_heap> *changed_values_stack)
8906 {
8907 variable *var = *slot;
8908
8909 if (var->onepart == ONEPART_VALUE)
8910 changed_values_stack->safe_push (dv_as_value (var->dv));
8911 else if (var->onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR)
8912 changed_values_stack->safe_push (DECL_RTL_KNOWN_SET (dv_as_decl (var->dv)));
8913
8914 return 1;
8915 }
8916
8917 /* Remove from changed_variables the entry whose DV corresponds to
8918 value or debug_expr VAL. */
8919 static void
8920 remove_value_from_changed_variables (rtx val)
8921 {
8922 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_rtx (val);
8923 variable **slot;
8924 variable *var;
8925
8926 slot = changed_variables->find_slot_with_hash (dv, dv_htab_hash (dv),
8927 NO_INSERT);
8928 var = *slot;
8929 var->in_changed_variables = false;
8930 changed_variables->clear_slot (slot);
8931 }
8932
8933 /* If VAL (a value or debug_expr) has backlinks to variables actively
8934 dependent on it in HTAB or in CHANGED_VARIABLES, mark them as
8935 changed, adding to CHANGED_VALUES_STACK any dependencies that may
8936 have dependencies of their own to notify. */
8937
8938 static void
8939 notify_dependents_of_changed_value (rtx val, variable_table_type *htab,
8940 vec<rtx, va_heap> *changed_values_stack)
8941 {
8942 variable **slot;
8943 variable *var;
8944 loc_exp_dep *led;
8945 decl_or_value dv = dv_from_rtx (val);
8946
8947 slot = changed_variables->find_slot_with_hash (dv, dv_htab_hash (dv),
8948 NO_INSERT);
8949 if (!slot)
8950 slot = htab->find_slot_with_hash (dv, dv_htab_hash (dv), NO_INSERT);
8951 if (!slot)
8952 slot = dropped_values->find_slot_with_hash (dv, dv_htab_hash (dv),
8953 NO_INSERT);
8954 var = *slot;
8955
8956 while ((led = VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (var)))
8957 {
8958 decl_or_value ldv = led->dv;
8959 variable *ivar;
8960
8961 /* Deactivate and remove the backlink, as it was “used up”. It
8962 makes no sense to attempt to notify the same entity again:
8963 either it will be recomputed and re-register an active
8964 dependency, or it will still have the changed mark. */
8965 if (led->next)
8966 led->next->pprev = led->pprev;
8967 if (led->pprev)
8968 *led->pprev = led->next;
8969 led->next = NULL;
8970 led->pprev = NULL;
8971
8972 if (dv_changed_p (ldv))
8973 continue;
8974
8975 switch (dv_onepart_p (ldv))
8976 {
8977 case ONEPART_VALUE:
8978 case ONEPART_DEXPR:
8979 set_dv_changed (ldv, true);
8980 changed_values_stack->safe_push (dv_as_rtx (ldv));
8981 break;
8982
8983 case ONEPART_VDECL:
8984 ivar = htab->find_with_hash (ldv, dv_htab_hash (ldv));
8985 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_DEP_LST (ivar));
8986 variable_was_changed (ivar, NULL);
8987 break;
8988
8989 case NOT_ONEPART:
8990 delete led;
8991 ivar = htab->find_with_hash (ldv, dv_htab_hash (ldv));
8992 if (ivar)
8993 {
8994 int i = ivar->n_var_parts;
8995 while (i--)
8996 {
8997 rtx loc = ivar->var_part[i].cur_loc;
8998
8999 if (loc && GET_CODE (loc) == MEM
9000 && XEXP (loc, 0) == val)
9001 {
9002 variable_was_changed (ivar, NULL);
9003 break;
9004 }
9005 }
9006 }
9007 break;
9008
9009 default:
9010 gcc_unreachable ();
9011 }
9012 }
9013 }
9014
9015 /* Take out of changed_variables any entries that don't refer to use
9016 variables. Back-propagate change notifications from values and
9017 debug_exprs to their active dependencies in HTAB or in
9018 CHANGED_VARIABLES. */
9019
9020 static void
9021 process_changed_values (variable_table_type *htab)
9022 {
9023 int i, n;
9024 rtx val;
9025 auto_vec<rtx, 20> changed_values_stack;
9026
9027 /* Move values from changed_variables to changed_values_stack. */
9028 changed_variables
9029 ->traverse <vec<rtx, va_heap>*, var_track_values_to_stack>
9030 (&changed_values_stack);
9031
9032 /* Back-propagate change notifications in values while popping
9033 them from the stack. */
9034 for (n = i = changed_values_stack.length ();
9035 i > 0; i = changed_values_stack.length ())
9036 {
9037 val = changed_values_stack.pop ();
9038 notify_dependents_of_changed_value (val, htab, &changed_values_stack);
9039
9040 /* This condition will hold when visiting each of the entries
9041 originally in changed_variables. We can't remove them
9042 earlier because this could drop the backlinks before we got a
9043 chance to use them. */
9044 if (i == n)
9045 {
9046 remove_value_from_changed_variables (val);
9047 n--;
9048 }
9049 }
9050 }
9051
9052 /* Emit NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION note for each variable from a chain
9053 CHANGED_VARIABLES and delete this chain. WHERE specifies whether
9054 the notes shall be emitted before of after instruction INSN. */
9055
9056 static void
9057 emit_notes_for_changes (rtx_insn *insn, enum emit_note_where where,
9058 shared_hash *vars)
9059 {
9060 emit_note_data data;
9061 variable_table_type *htab = shared_hash_htab (vars);
9062
9063 if (!changed_variables->elements ())
9064 return;
9065
9066 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
9067 process_changed_values (htab);
9068
9069 data.insn = insn;
9070 data.where = where;
9071 data.vars = htab;
9072
9073 changed_variables
9074 ->traverse <emit_note_data*, emit_note_insn_var_location> (&data);
9075 }
9076
9077 /* Add variable *SLOT to the chain CHANGED_VARIABLES if it differs from the
9078 same variable in hash table DATA or is not there at all. */
9079
9080 int
9081 emit_notes_for_differences_1 (variable **slot, variable_table_type *new_vars)
9082 {
9083 variable *old_var, *new_var;
9084
9085 old_var = *slot;
9086 new_var = new_vars->find_with_hash (old_var->dv, dv_htab_hash (old_var->dv));
9087
9088 if (!new_var)
9089 {
9090 /* Variable has disappeared. */
9091 variable *empty_var = NULL;
9092
9093 if (old_var->onepart == ONEPART_VALUE
9094 || old_var->onepart == ONEPART_DEXPR)
9095 {
9096 empty_var = variable_from_dropped (old_var->dv, NO_INSERT);
9097 if (empty_var)
9098 {
9099 gcc_checking_assert (!empty_var->in_changed_variables);
9100 if (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var))
9101 {
9102 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var);
9103 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var) = NULL;
9104 }
9105 else
9106 gcc_checking_assert (!VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var));
9107 }
9108 }
9109
9110 if (!empty_var)
9111 {
9112 empty_var = onepart_pool_allocate (old_var->onepart);
9113 empty_var->dv = old_var->dv;
9114 empty_var->refcount = 0;
9115 empty_var->n_var_parts = 0;
9116 empty_var->onepart = old_var->onepart;
9117 empty_var->in_changed_variables = false;
9118 }
9119
9120 if (empty_var->onepart)
9121 {
9122 /* Propagate the auxiliary data to (ultimately)
9123 changed_variables. */
9124 empty_var->var_part[0].loc_chain = NULL;
9125 empty_var->var_part[0].cur_loc = NULL;
9126 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (empty_var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var);
9127 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var) = NULL;
9128 }
9129 variable_was_changed (empty_var, NULL);
9130 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
9131 return 1;
9132 }
9133 /* Update cur_loc and one-part auxiliary data, before new_var goes
9134 through variable_was_changed. */
9135 if (old_var != new_var && new_var->onepart)
9136 {
9137 gcc_checking_assert (VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var) == NULL);
9138 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (new_var) = VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var);
9139 VAR_LOC_1PAUX (old_var) = NULL;
9140 new_var->var_part[0].cur_loc = old_var->var_part[0].cur_loc;
9141 }
9142 if (variable_different_p (old_var, new_var))
9143 variable_was_changed (new_var, NULL);
9144
9145 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
9146 return 1;
9147 }
9148
9149 /* Add variable *SLOT to the chain CHANGED_VARIABLES if it is not in hash
9150 table DATA. */
9151
9152 int
9153 emit_notes_for_differences_2 (variable **slot, variable_table_type *old_vars)
9154 {
9155 variable *old_var, *new_var;
9156
9157 new_var = *slot;
9158 old_var = old_vars->find_with_hash (new_var->dv, dv_htab_hash (new_var->dv));
9159 if (!old_var)
9160 {
9161 int i;
9162 for (i = 0; i < new_var->n_var_parts; i++)
9163 new_var->var_part[i].cur_loc = NULL;
9164 variable_was_changed (new_var, NULL);
9165 }
9166
9167 /* Continue traversing the hash table. */
9168 return 1;
9169 }
9170
9171 /* Emit notes before INSN for differences between dataflow sets OLD_SET and
9172 NEW_SET. */
9173
9174 static void
9175 emit_notes_for_differences (rtx_insn *insn, dataflow_set *old_set,
9176 dataflow_set *new_set)
9177 {
9178 shared_hash_htab (old_set->vars)
9179 ->traverse <variable_table_type *, emit_notes_for_differences_1>
9180 (shared_hash_htab (new_set->vars));
9181 shared_hash_htab (new_set->vars)
9182 ->traverse <variable_table_type *, emit_notes_for_differences_2>
9183 (shared_hash_htab (old_set->vars));
9184 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN, new_set->vars);
9185 }
9186
9187 /* Return the next insn after INSN that is not a NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION. */
9188
9189 static rtx_insn *
9190 next_non_note_insn_var_location (rtx_insn *insn)
9191 {
9192 while (insn)
9193 {
9194 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn);
9195 if (insn == 0
9196 || !NOTE_P (insn)
9197 || NOTE_KIND (insn) != NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
9198 break;
9199 }
9200
9201 return insn;
9202 }
9203
9204 /* Emit the notes for changes of location parts in the basic block BB. */
9205
9206 static void
9207 emit_notes_in_bb (basic_block bb, dataflow_set *set)
9208 {
9209 unsigned int i;
9210 micro_operation *mo;
9211
9212 dataflow_set_clear (set);
9213 dataflow_set_copy (set, &VTI (bb)->in);
9214
9215 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (VTI (bb)->mos, i, mo)
9216 {
9217 rtx_insn *insn = mo->insn;
9218 rtx_insn *next_insn = next_non_note_insn_var_location (insn);
9219
9220 switch (mo->type)
9221 {
9222 case MO_CALL:
9223 dataflow_set_clear_at_call (set, insn);
9224 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_CALL_INSN, set->vars);
9225 {
9226 rtx arguments = mo->u.loc, *p = &arguments;
9227 while (*p)
9228 {
9229 XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 1)
9230 = vt_expand_loc (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 1),
9231 shared_hash_htab (set->vars));
9232 /* If expansion is successful, keep it in the list. */
9233 if (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 1))
9234 {
9235 XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 1)
9236 = copy_rtx_if_shared (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 1));
9237 p = &XEXP (*p, 1);
9238 }
9239 /* Otherwise, if the following item is data_value for it,
9240 drop it too too. */
9241 else if (XEXP (*p, 1)
9242 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 0))
9243 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 1), 0), 0))
9244 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 1), 0), 0),
9245 0))
9246 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 0), 0))
9247 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (*p, 1), 0),
9248 0), 0)))
9249 *p = XEXP (XEXP (*p, 1), 1);
9250 /* Just drop this item. */
9251 else
9252 *p = XEXP (*p, 1);
9253 }
9254 add_reg_note (insn, REG_CALL_ARG_LOCATION, arguments);
9255 }
9256 break;
9257
9258 case MO_USE:
9259 {
9260 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
9261
9262 if (REG_P (loc))
9263 var_reg_set (set, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED, NULL);
9264 else
9265 var_mem_set (set, loc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED, NULL);
9266
9267 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN, set->vars);
9268 }
9269 break;
9270
9271 case MO_VAL_LOC:
9272 {
9273 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
9274 rtx val, vloc;
9275 tree var;
9276
9277 if (GET_CODE (loc) == CONCAT)
9278 {
9279 val = XEXP (loc, 0);
9280 vloc = XEXP (loc, 1);
9281 }
9282 else
9283 {
9284 val = NULL_RTX;
9285 vloc = loc;
9286 }
9287
9288 var = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (vloc);
9289
9290 clobber_variable_part (set, NULL_RTX,
9291 dv_from_decl (var), 0, NULL_RTX);
9292 if (val)
9293 {
9294 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
9295 val_resolve (set, val, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc), insn);
9296 set_variable_part (set, val, dv_from_decl (var), 0,
9297 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX,
9298 INSERT);
9299 }
9300 else if (!VAR_LOC_UNKNOWN_P (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc)))
9301 set_variable_part (set, PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (vloc),
9302 dv_from_decl (var), 0,
9303 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL_RTX,
9304 INSERT);
9305
9306 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN, set->vars);
9307 }
9308 break;
9309
9310 case MO_VAL_USE:
9311 {
9312 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
9313 rtx val, vloc, uloc;
9314
9315 vloc = uloc = XEXP (loc, 1);
9316 val = XEXP (loc, 0);
9317
9318 if (GET_CODE (val) == CONCAT)
9319 {
9320 uloc = XEXP (val, 1);
9321 val = XEXP (val, 0);
9322 }
9323
9324 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
9325 val_resolve (set, val, vloc, insn);
9326 else
9327 val_store (set, val, uloc, insn, false);
9328
9329 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc))
9330 {
9331 if (GET_CODE (uloc) == REG)
9332 var_reg_set (set, uloc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED,
9333 NULL);
9334 else if (GET_CODE (uloc) == MEM)
9335 var_mem_set (set, uloc, VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED,
9336 NULL);
9337 }
9338
9339 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN, set->vars);
9340 }
9341 break;
9342
9343 case MO_VAL_SET:
9344 {
9345 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
9346 rtx val, vloc, uloc;
9347 rtx dstv, srcv;
9348
9349 vloc = loc;
9350 uloc = XEXP (vloc, 1);
9351 val = XEXP (vloc, 0);
9352 vloc = uloc;
9353
9354 if (GET_CODE (uloc) == SET)
9355 {
9356 dstv = SET_DEST (uloc);
9357 srcv = SET_SRC (uloc);
9358 }
9359 else
9360 {
9361 dstv = uloc;
9362 srcv = NULL;
9363 }
9364
9365 if (GET_CODE (val) == CONCAT)
9366 {
9367 dstv = vloc = XEXP (val, 1);
9368 val = XEXP (val, 0);
9369 }
9370
9371 if (GET_CODE (vloc) == SET)
9372 {
9373 srcv = SET_SRC (vloc);
9374
9375 gcc_assert (val != srcv);
9376 gcc_assert (vloc == uloc || VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc));
9377
9378 dstv = vloc = SET_DEST (vloc);
9379
9380 if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
9381 val_resolve (set, val, srcv, insn);
9382 }
9383 else if (VAL_NEEDS_RESOLUTION (loc))
9384 {
9385 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (uloc) == SET
9386 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (uloc)) == REG);
9387 val_resolve (set, val, SET_SRC (uloc), insn);
9388 }
9389
9390 if (VAL_HOLDS_TRACK_EXPR (loc))
9391 {
9392 if (VAL_EXPR_IS_CLOBBERED (loc))
9393 {
9394 if (REG_P (uloc))
9395 var_reg_delete (set, uloc, true);
9396 else if (MEM_P (uloc))
9397 {
9398 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv));
9399 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv) == MEM_ATTRS (uloc));
9400 var_mem_delete (set, dstv, true);
9401 }
9402 }
9403 else
9404 {
9405 bool copied_p = VAL_EXPR_IS_COPIED (loc);
9406 rtx src = NULL, dst = uloc;
9407 enum var_init_status status = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
9408
9409 if (GET_CODE (uloc) == SET)
9410 {
9411 src = SET_SRC (uloc);
9412 dst = SET_DEST (uloc);
9413 }
9414
9415 if (copied_p)
9416 {
9417 status = find_src_status (set, src);
9418
9419 src = find_src_set_src (set, src);
9420 }
9421
9422 if (REG_P (dst))
9423 var_reg_delete_and_set (set, dst, !copied_p,
9424 status, srcv);
9425 else if (MEM_P (dst))
9426 {
9427 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dstv));
9428 gcc_assert (MEM_ATTRS (dstv) == MEM_ATTRS (dst));
9429 var_mem_delete_and_set (set, dstv, !copied_p,
9430 status, srcv);
9431 }
9432 }
9433 }
9434 else if (REG_P (uloc))
9435 var_regno_delete (set, REGNO (uloc));
9436 else if (MEM_P (uloc))
9437 {
9438 gcc_checking_assert (GET_CODE (vloc) == MEM);
9439 gcc_checking_assert (vloc == dstv);
9440 if (vloc != dstv)
9441 clobber_overlapping_mems (set, vloc);
9442 }
9443
9444 val_store (set, val, dstv, insn, true);
9445
9446 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN,
9447 set->vars);
9448 }
9449 break;
9450
9451 case MO_SET:
9452 {
9453 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
9454 rtx set_src = NULL;
9455
9456 if (GET_CODE (loc) == SET)
9457 {
9458 set_src = SET_SRC (loc);
9459 loc = SET_DEST (loc);
9460 }
9461
9462 if (REG_P (loc))
9463 var_reg_delete_and_set (set, loc, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
9464 set_src);
9465 else
9466 var_mem_delete_and_set (set, loc, true, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED,
9467 set_src);
9468
9469 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN,
9470 set->vars);
9471 }
9472 break;
9473
9474 case MO_COPY:
9475 {
9476 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
9477 enum var_init_status src_status;
9478 rtx set_src = NULL;
9479
9480 if (GET_CODE (loc) == SET)
9481 {
9482 set_src = SET_SRC (loc);
9483 loc = SET_DEST (loc);
9484 }
9485
9486 src_status = find_src_status (set, set_src);
9487 set_src = find_src_set_src (set, set_src);
9488
9489 if (REG_P (loc))
9490 var_reg_delete_and_set (set, loc, false, src_status, set_src);
9491 else
9492 var_mem_delete_and_set (set, loc, false, src_status, set_src);
9493
9494 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN,
9495 set->vars);
9496 }
9497 break;
9498
9499 case MO_USE_NO_VAR:
9500 {
9501 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
9502
9503 if (REG_P (loc))
9504 var_reg_delete (set, loc, false);
9505 else
9506 var_mem_delete (set, loc, false);
9507
9508 emit_notes_for_changes (insn, EMIT_NOTE_AFTER_INSN, set->vars);
9509 }
9510 break;
9511
9512 case MO_CLOBBER:
9513 {
9514 rtx loc = mo->u.loc;
9515
9516 if (REG_P (loc))
9517 var_reg_delete (set, loc, true);
9518 else
9519 var_mem_delete (set, loc, true);
9520
9521 emit_notes_for_changes (next_insn, EMIT_NOTE_BEFORE_INSN,
9522 set->vars);
9523 }
9524 break;
9525
9526 case MO_ADJUST:
9527 set->stack_adjust += mo->u.adjust;
9528 break;
9529 }
9530 }
9531 }
9532
9533 /* Emit notes for the whole function. */
9534
9535 static void
9536 vt_emit_notes (void)
9537 {
9538 basic_block bb;
9539 dataflow_set cur;
9540
9541 gcc_assert (!changed_variables->elements ());
9542
9543 /* Free memory occupied by the out hash tables, as they aren't used
9544 anymore. */
9545 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
9546 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb)->out);
9547
9548 /* Enable emitting notes by functions (mainly by set_variable_part and
9549 delete_variable_part). */
9550 emit_notes = true;
9551
9552 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
9553 dropped_values = new variable_table_type (cselib_get_next_uid () * 2);
9554
9555 dataflow_set_init (&cur);
9556
9557 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
9558 {
9559 /* Emit the notes for changes of variable locations between two
9560 subsequent basic blocks. */
9561 emit_notes_for_differences (BB_HEAD (bb), &cur, &VTI (bb)->in);
9562
9563 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
9564 local_get_addr_cache = new hash_map<rtx, rtx>;
9565
9566 /* Emit the notes for the changes in the basic block itself. */
9567 emit_notes_in_bb (bb, &cur);
9568
9569 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
9570 delete local_get_addr_cache;
9571 local_get_addr_cache = NULL;
9572
9573 /* Free memory occupied by the in hash table, we won't need it
9574 again. */
9575 dataflow_set_clear (&VTI (bb)->in);
9576 }
9577
9578 if (flag_checking)
9579 shared_hash_htab (cur.vars)
9580 ->traverse <variable_table_type *, emit_notes_for_differences_1>
9581 (shared_hash_htab (empty_shared_hash));
9582
9583 dataflow_set_destroy (&cur);
9584
9585 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
9586 delete dropped_values;
9587 dropped_values = NULL;
9588
9589 emit_notes = false;
9590 }
9591
9592 /* If there is a declaration and offset associated with register/memory RTL
9593 assign declaration to *DECLP and offset to *OFFSETP, and return true. */
9594
9595 static bool
9596 vt_get_decl_and_offset (rtx rtl, tree *declp, poly_int64 *offsetp)
9597 {
9598 if (REG_P (rtl))
9599 {
9600 if (REG_ATTRS (rtl))
9601 {
9602 *declp = REG_EXPR (rtl);
9603 *offsetp = REG_OFFSET (rtl);
9604 return true;
9605 }
9606 }
9607 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == PARALLEL)
9608 {
9609 tree decl = NULL_TREE;
9610 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = MAX_VAR_PARTS;
9611 int len = XVECLEN (rtl, 0), i;
9612
9613 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
9614 {
9615 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, i), 0);
9616 if (!REG_P (reg) || !REG_ATTRS (reg))
9617 break;
9618 if (!decl)
9619 decl = REG_EXPR (reg);
9620 if (REG_EXPR (reg) != decl)
9621 break;
9622 HOST_WIDE_INT this_offset;
9623 if (!track_offset_p (REG_OFFSET (reg), &this_offset))
9624 break;
9625 offset = MIN (offset, this_offset);
9626 }
9627
9628 if (i == len)
9629 {
9630 *declp = decl;
9631 *offsetp = offset;
9632 return true;
9633 }
9634 }
9635 else if (MEM_P (rtl))
9636 {
9637 if (MEM_ATTRS (rtl))
9638 {
9639 *declp = MEM_EXPR (rtl);
9640 *offsetp = int_mem_offset (rtl);
9641 return true;
9642 }
9643 }
9644 return false;
9645 }
9646
9647 /* Record the value for the ENTRY_VALUE of RTL as a global equivalence
9648 of VAL. */
9649
9650 static void
9651 record_entry_value (cselib_val *val, rtx rtl)
9652 {
9653 rtx ev = gen_rtx_ENTRY_VALUE (GET_MODE (rtl));
9654
9655 ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (ev) = rtl;
9656
9657 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (val, ev, get_insns ());
9658 }
9659
9660 /* Insert function parameter PARM in IN and OUT sets of ENTRY_BLOCK. */
9661
9662 static void
9663 vt_add_function_parameter (tree parm)
9664 {
9665 rtx decl_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (parm);
9666 rtx incoming = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (parm);
9667 tree decl;
9668 machine_mode mode;
9669 poly_int64 offset;
9670 dataflow_set *out;
9671 decl_or_value dv;
9672 bool incoming_ok = true;
9673
9674 if (TREE_CODE (parm) != PARM_DECL)
9675 return;
9676
9677 if (!decl_rtl || !incoming)
9678 return;
9679
9680 if (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == BLKmode || GET_MODE (incoming) == BLKmode)
9681 return;
9682
9683 /* If there is a DRAP register or a pseudo in internal_arg_pointer,
9684 rewrite the incoming location of parameters passed on the stack
9685 into MEMs based on the argument pointer, so that incoming doesn't
9686 depend on a pseudo. */
9687 poly_int64 incoming_offset = 0;
9688 if (MEM_P (incoming)
9689 && (strip_offset (XEXP (incoming, 0), &incoming_offset)
9690 == crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer))
9691 {
9692 HOST_WIDE_INT off = -FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
9693 incoming
9694 = replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming,
9695 plus_constant (Pmode,
9696 arg_pointer_rtx,
9697 off + incoming_offset));
9698 }
9699
9700 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
9701 /* DECL_INCOMING_RTL uses the INCOMING_REGNO of parameter registers.
9702 If the target machine has an explicit window save instruction, the
9703 actual entry value is the corresponding OUTGOING_REGNO instead. */
9704 if (HAVE_window_save && !crtl->uses_only_leaf_regs)
9705 {
9706 if (REG_P (incoming)
9707 && HARD_REGISTER_P (incoming)
9708 && OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (incoming)) != REGNO (incoming))
9709 {
9710 parm_reg p;
9711 p.incoming = incoming;
9712 incoming
9713 = gen_rtx_REG_offset (incoming, GET_MODE (incoming),
9714 OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (incoming)), 0);
9715 p.outgoing = incoming;
9716 vec_safe_push (windowed_parm_regs, p);
9717 }
9718 else if (GET_CODE (incoming) == PARALLEL)
9719 {
9720 rtx outgoing
9721 = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (incoming, 0)));
9722 int i;
9723
9724 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (incoming, 0); i++)
9725 {
9726 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (incoming, 0, i), 0);
9727 parm_reg p;
9728 p.incoming = reg;
9729 reg = gen_rtx_REG_offset (reg, GET_MODE (reg),
9730 OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (reg)), 0);
9731 p.outgoing = reg;
9732 XVECEXP (outgoing, 0, i)
9733 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, reg,
9734 XEXP (XVECEXP (incoming, 0, i), 1));
9735 vec_safe_push (windowed_parm_regs, p);
9736 }
9737
9738 incoming = outgoing;
9739 }
9740 else if (MEM_P (incoming)
9741 && REG_P (XEXP (incoming, 0))
9742 && HARD_REGISTER_P (XEXP (incoming, 0)))
9743 {
9744 rtx reg = XEXP (incoming, 0);
9745 if (OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (reg)) != REGNO (reg))
9746 {
9747 parm_reg p;
9748 p.incoming = reg;
9749 reg = gen_raw_REG (GET_MODE (reg), OUTGOING_REGNO (REGNO (reg)));
9750 p.outgoing = reg;
9751 vec_safe_push (windowed_parm_regs, p);
9752 incoming = replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming, reg);
9753 }
9754 }
9755 }
9756 #endif
9757
9758 if (!vt_get_decl_and_offset (incoming, &decl, &offset))
9759 {
9760 incoming_ok = false;
9761 if (MEM_P (incoming))
9762 {
9763 /* This means argument is passed by invisible reference. */
9764 offset = 0;
9765 decl = parm;
9766 }
9767 else
9768 {
9769 if (!vt_get_decl_and_offset (decl_rtl, &decl, &offset))
9770 return;
9771 offset += byte_lowpart_offset (GET_MODE (incoming),
9772 GET_MODE (decl_rtl));
9773 }
9774 }
9775
9776 if (!decl)
9777 return;
9778
9779 if (parm != decl)
9780 {
9781 /* If that DECL_RTL wasn't a pseudo that got spilled to
9782 memory, bail out. Otherwise, the spill slot sharing code
9783 will force the memory to reference spill_slot_decl (%sfp),
9784 so we don't match above. That's ok, the pseudo must have
9785 referenced the entire parameter, so just reset OFFSET. */
9786 if (decl != get_spill_slot_decl (false))
9787 return;
9788 offset = 0;
9789 }
9790
9791 HOST_WIDE_INT const_offset;
9792 if (!track_loc_p (incoming, parm, offset, false, &mode, &const_offset))
9793 return;
9794
9795 out = &VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun))->out;
9796
9797 dv = dv_from_decl (parm);
9798
9799 if (target_for_debug_bind (parm)
9800 /* We can't deal with these right now, because this kind of
9801 variable is single-part. ??? We could handle parallels
9802 that describe multiple locations for the same single
9803 value, but ATM we don't. */
9804 && GET_CODE (incoming) != PARALLEL)
9805 {
9806 cselib_val *val;
9807 rtx lowpart;
9808
9809 /* ??? We shouldn't ever hit this, but it may happen because
9810 arguments passed by invisible reference aren't dealt with
9811 above: incoming-rtl will have Pmode rather than the
9812 expected mode for the type. */
9813 if (const_offset)
9814 return;
9815
9816 lowpart = var_lowpart (mode, incoming);
9817 if (!lowpart)
9818 return;
9819
9820 val = cselib_lookup_from_insn (lowpart, mode, true,
9821 VOIDmode, get_insns ());
9822
9823 /* ??? Float-typed values in memory are not handled by
9824 cselib. */
9825 if (val)
9826 {
9827 preserve_value (val);
9828 set_variable_part (out, val->val_rtx, dv, const_offset,
9829 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, INSERT);
9830 dv = dv_from_value (val->val_rtx);
9831 }
9832
9833 if (MEM_P (incoming))
9834 {
9835 val = cselib_lookup_from_insn (XEXP (incoming, 0), mode, true,
9836 VOIDmode, get_insns ());
9837 if (val)
9838 {
9839 preserve_value (val);
9840 incoming = replace_equiv_address_nv (incoming, val->val_rtx);
9841 }
9842 }
9843 }
9844
9845 if (REG_P (incoming))
9846 {
9847 incoming = var_lowpart (mode, incoming);
9848 gcc_assert (REGNO (incoming) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
9849 attrs_list_insert (&out->regs[REGNO (incoming)], dv, const_offset,
9850 incoming);
9851 set_variable_part (out, incoming, dv, const_offset,
9852 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, INSERT);
9853 if (dv_is_value_p (dv))
9854 {
9855 record_entry_value (CSELIB_VAL_PTR (dv_as_value (dv)), incoming);
9856 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (parm)) == REFERENCE_TYPE
9857 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm))))
9858 {
9859 machine_mode indmode
9860 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (parm)));
9861 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (indmode, incoming);
9862 cselib_val *val = cselib_lookup_from_insn (mem, indmode, true,
9863 VOIDmode,
9864 get_insns ());
9865 if (val)
9866 {
9867 preserve_value (val);
9868 record_entry_value (val, mem);
9869 set_variable_part (out, mem, dv_from_value (val->val_rtx), 0,
9870 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, INSERT);
9871 }
9872 }
9873 }
9874 }
9875 else if (GET_CODE (incoming) == PARALLEL && !dv_onepart_p (dv))
9876 {
9877 int i;
9878
9879 /* The following code relies on vt_get_decl_and_offset returning true for
9880 incoming, which might not be always the case. */
9881 if (!incoming_ok)
9882 return;
9883 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (incoming, 0); i++)
9884 {
9885 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (incoming, 0, i), 0);
9886 /* vt_get_decl_and_offset has already checked that the offset
9887 is a valid variable part. */
9888 const_offset = get_tracked_reg_offset (reg);
9889 gcc_assert (REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
9890 attrs_list_insert (&out->regs[REGNO (reg)], dv, const_offset, reg);
9891 set_variable_part (out, reg, dv, const_offset,
9892 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, INSERT);
9893 }
9894 }
9895 else if (MEM_P (incoming))
9896 {
9897 incoming = var_lowpart (mode, incoming);
9898 set_variable_part (out, incoming, dv, const_offset,
9899 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED, NULL, INSERT);
9900 }
9901 }
9902
9903 /* Insert function parameters to IN and OUT sets of ENTRY_BLOCK. */
9904
9905 static void
9906 vt_add_function_parameters (void)
9907 {
9908 tree parm;
9909
9910 for (parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl);
9911 parm; parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm))
9912 vt_add_function_parameter (parm);
9913
9914 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl)))
9915 {
9916 tree vexpr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (DECL_RESULT (current_function_decl));
9917
9918 if (TREE_CODE (vexpr) == INDIRECT_REF)
9919 vexpr = TREE_OPERAND (vexpr, 0);
9920
9921 if (TREE_CODE (vexpr) == PARM_DECL
9922 && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (vexpr)
9923 && !DECL_IGNORED_P (vexpr)
9924 && DECL_NAMELESS (vexpr))
9925 vt_add_function_parameter (vexpr);
9926 }
9927 }
9928
9929 /* Initialize cfa_base_rtx, create a preserved VALUE for it and
9930 ensure it isn't flushed during cselib_reset_table.
9931 Can be called only if frame_pointer_rtx resp. arg_pointer_rtx
9932 has been eliminated. */
9933
9934 static void
9935 vt_init_cfa_base (void)
9936 {
9937 cselib_val *val;
9938
9939 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
9940 cfa_base_rtx = frame_pointer_rtx;
9941 cfa_base_offset = -FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
9942 #else
9943 cfa_base_rtx = arg_pointer_rtx;
9944 cfa_base_offset = -ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
9945 #endif
9946 if (cfa_base_rtx == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
9947 || !fixed_regs[REGNO (cfa_base_rtx)])
9948 {
9949 cfa_base_rtx = NULL_RTX;
9950 return;
9951 }
9952 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
9953 return;
9954
9955 /* Tell alias analysis that cfa_base_rtx should share
9956 find_base_term value with stack pointer or hard frame pointer. */
9957 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
9958 vt_equate_reg_base_value (cfa_base_rtx, stack_pointer_rtx);
9959 else if (!crtl->stack_realign_tried)
9960 vt_equate_reg_base_value (cfa_base_rtx, hard_frame_pointer_rtx);
9961
9962 val = cselib_lookup_from_insn (cfa_base_rtx, GET_MODE (cfa_base_rtx), 1,
9963 VOIDmode, get_insns ());
9964 preserve_value (val);
9965 cselib_preserve_cfa_base_value (val, REGNO (cfa_base_rtx));
9966 }
9967
9968 /* Reemit INSN, a MARKER_DEBUG_INSN, as a note. */
9969
9970 static rtx_insn *
9971 reemit_marker_as_note (rtx_insn *insn)
9972 {
9973 gcc_checking_assert (DEBUG_MARKER_INSN_P (insn));
9974
9975 enum insn_note kind = INSN_DEBUG_MARKER_KIND (insn);
9976
9977 switch (kind)
9978 {
9979 case NOTE_INSN_BEGIN_STMT:
9980 case NOTE_INSN_INLINE_ENTRY:
9981 {
9982 rtx_insn *note = NULL;
9983 if (cfun->debug_nonbind_markers)
9984 {
9985 note = emit_note_before (kind, insn);
9986 NOTE_MARKER_LOCATION (note) = INSN_LOCATION (insn);
9987 }
9988 delete_insn (insn);
9989 return note;
9990 }
9991
9992 default:
9993 gcc_unreachable ();
9994 }
9995 }
9996
9997 /* Allocate and initialize the data structures for variable tracking
9998 and parse the RTL to get the micro operations. */
9999
10000 static bool
10001 vt_initialize (void)
10002 {
10003 basic_block bb;
10004 poly_int64 fp_cfa_offset = -1;
10005
10006 alloc_aux_for_blocks (sizeof (variable_tracking_info));
10007
10008 empty_shared_hash = shared_hash_pool.allocate ();
10009 empty_shared_hash->refcount = 1;
10010 empty_shared_hash->htab = new variable_table_type (1);
10011 changed_variables = new variable_table_type (10);
10012
10013 /* Init the IN and OUT sets. */
10014 FOR_ALL_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
10015 {
10016 VTI (bb)->visited = false;
10017 VTI (bb)->flooded = false;
10018 dataflow_set_init (&VTI (bb)->in);
10019 dataflow_set_init (&VTI (bb)->out);
10020 VTI (bb)->permp = NULL;
10021 }
10022
10023 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
10024 {
10025 cselib_init (CSELIB_RECORD_MEMORY | CSELIB_PRESERVE_CONSTANTS);
10026 scratch_regs = BITMAP_ALLOC (NULL);
10027 preserved_values.create (256);
10028 global_get_addr_cache = new hash_map<rtx, rtx>;
10029 }
10030 else
10031 {
10032 scratch_regs = NULL;
10033 global_get_addr_cache = NULL;
10034 }
10035
10036 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
10037 {
10038 rtx reg, expr;
10039 int ofst;
10040 cselib_val *val;
10041
10042 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10043 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10044 ofst = FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10045 #else
10046 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10047 ofst = ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10048 #endif
10049
10050 ofst -= INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET;
10051
10052 val = cselib_lookup_from_insn (reg, GET_MODE (reg), 1,
10053 VOIDmode, get_insns ());
10054 preserve_value (val);
10055 if (reg != hard_frame_pointer_rtx && fixed_regs[REGNO (reg)])
10056 cselib_preserve_cfa_base_value (val, REGNO (reg));
10057 expr = plus_constant (GET_MODE (stack_pointer_rtx),
10058 stack_pointer_rtx, -ofst);
10059 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (val, expr, get_insns ());
10060
10061 if (ofst)
10062 {
10063 val = cselib_lookup_from_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
10064 GET_MODE (stack_pointer_rtx), 1,
10065 VOIDmode, get_insns ());
10066 preserve_value (val);
10067 expr = plus_constant (GET_MODE (reg), reg, ofst);
10068 cselib_add_permanent_equiv (val, expr, get_insns ());
10069 }
10070 }
10071
10072 /* In order to factor out the adjustments made to the stack pointer or to
10073 the hard frame pointer and thus be able to use DW_OP_fbreg operations
10074 instead of individual location lists, we're going to rewrite MEMs based
10075 on them into MEMs based on the CFA by de-eliminating stack_pointer_rtx
10076 or hard_frame_pointer_rtx to the virtual CFA pointer frame_pointer_rtx
10077 resp. arg_pointer_rtx. We can do this either when there is no frame
10078 pointer in the function and stack adjustments are consistent for all
10079 basic blocks or when there is a frame pointer and no stack realignment.
10080 But we first have to check that frame_pointer_rtx resp. arg_pointer_rtx
10081 has been eliminated. */
10082 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
10083 {
10084 rtx reg, elim;
10085
10086 if (!vt_stack_adjustments ())
10087 return false;
10088
10089 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10090 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10091 #else
10092 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10093 #endif
10094 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10095 if (elim != reg)
10096 {
10097 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10098 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10099 if (elim == stack_pointer_rtx)
10100 vt_init_cfa_base ();
10101 }
10102 }
10103 else if (!crtl->stack_realign_tried)
10104 {
10105 rtx reg, elim;
10106
10107 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10108 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10109 fp_cfa_offset = FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10110 #else
10111 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10112 fp_cfa_offset = ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10113 #endif
10114 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10115 if (elim != reg)
10116 {
10117 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10118 {
10119 fp_cfa_offset -= rtx_to_poly_int64 (XEXP (elim, 1));
10120 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10121 }
10122 if (elim != hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
10123 fp_cfa_offset = -1;
10124 }
10125 else
10126 fp_cfa_offset = -1;
10127 }
10128
10129 /* If the stack is realigned and a DRAP register is used, we're going to
10130 rewrite MEMs based on it representing incoming locations of parameters
10131 passed on the stack into MEMs based on the argument pointer. Although
10132 we aren't going to rewrite other MEMs, we still need to initialize the
10133 virtual CFA pointer in order to ensure that the argument pointer will
10134 be seen as a constant throughout the function.
10135
10136 ??? This doesn't work if FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET is defined. */
10137 else if (stack_realign_drap)
10138 {
10139 rtx reg, elim;
10140
10141 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10142 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10143 #else
10144 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10145 #endif
10146 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10147 if (elim != reg)
10148 {
10149 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10150 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10151 if (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
10152 vt_init_cfa_base ();
10153 }
10154 }
10155
10156 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment = -1;
10157
10158 vt_add_function_parameters ();
10159
10160 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
10161 {
10162 rtx_insn *insn;
10163 HOST_WIDE_INT pre, post = 0;
10164 basic_block first_bb, last_bb;
10165
10166 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
10167 {
10168 cselib_record_sets_hook = add_with_sets;
10169 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
10170 fprintf (dump_file, "first value: %i\n",
10171 cselib_get_next_uid ());
10172 }
10173
10174 first_bb = bb;
10175 for (;;)
10176 {
10177 edge e;
10178 if (bb->next_bb == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun)
10179 || ! single_pred_p (bb->next_bb))
10180 break;
10181 e = find_edge (bb, bb->next_bb);
10182 if (! e || (e->flags & EDGE_FALLTHRU) == 0)
10183 break;
10184 bb = bb->next_bb;
10185 }
10186 last_bb = bb;
10187
10188 /* Add the micro-operations to the vector. */
10189 FOR_BB_BETWEEN (bb, first_bb, last_bb->next_bb, next_bb)
10190 {
10191 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust;
10192 VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust = VTI (bb)->in.stack_adjust;
10193
10194 rtx_insn *next;
10195 FOR_BB_INSNS_SAFE (bb, insn, next)
10196 {
10197 if (INSN_P (insn))
10198 {
10199 if (!frame_pointer_needed)
10200 {
10201 insn_stack_adjust_offset_pre_post (insn, &pre, &post);
10202 if (pre)
10203 {
10204 micro_operation mo;
10205 mo.type = MO_ADJUST;
10206 mo.u.adjust = pre;
10207 mo.insn = insn;
10208 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
10209 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn), bb, insn,
10210 MO_ADJUST, dump_file);
10211 VTI (bb)->mos.safe_push (mo);
10212 }
10213 }
10214
10215 cselib_hook_called = false;
10216 adjust_insn (bb, insn);
10217
10218 if (!frame_pointer_needed && pre)
10219 VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust += pre;
10220
10221 if (DEBUG_MARKER_INSN_P (insn))
10222 {
10223 reemit_marker_as_note (insn);
10224 continue;
10225 }
10226
10227 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
10228 {
10229 if (CALL_P (insn))
10230 prepare_call_arguments (bb, insn);
10231 cselib_process_insn (insn);
10232 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
10233 {
10234 if (dump_flags & TDF_SLIM)
10235 dump_insn_slim (dump_file, insn);
10236 else
10237 print_rtl_single (dump_file, insn);
10238 dump_cselib_table (dump_file);
10239 }
10240 }
10241 if (!cselib_hook_called)
10242 add_with_sets (insn, 0, 0);
10243 cancel_changes (0);
10244
10245 if (!frame_pointer_needed && post)
10246 {
10247 micro_operation mo;
10248 mo.type = MO_ADJUST;
10249 mo.u.adjust = post;
10250 mo.insn = insn;
10251 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
10252 log_op_type (PATTERN (insn), bb, insn,
10253 MO_ADJUST, dump_file);
10254 VTI (bb)->mos.safe_push (mo);
10255 VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust += post;
10256 }
10257
10258 if (maybe_ne (fp_cfa_offset, -1)
10259 && known_eq (hard_frame_pointer_adjustment, -1)
10260 && fp_setter_insn (insn))
10261 {
10262 vt_init_cfa_base ();
10263 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment = fp_cfa_offset;
10264 /* Disassociate sp from fp now. */
10265 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
10266 {
10267 cselib_val *v;
10268 cselib_invalidate_rtx (stack_pointer_rtx);
10269 v = cselib_lookup (stack_pointer_rtx, Pmode, 1,
10270 VOIDmode);
10271 if (v && !cselib_preserved_value_p (v))
10272 {
10273 cselib_set_value_sp_based (v);
10274 preserve_value (v);
10275 }
10276 }
10277 }
10278 }
10279 }
10280 gcc_assert (offset == VTI (bb)->out.stack_adjust);
10281 }
10282
10283 bb = last_bb;
10284
10285 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
10286 {
10287 cselib_preserve_only_values ();
10288 cselib_reset_table (cselib_get_next_uid ());
10289 cselib_record_sets_hook = NULL;
10290 }
10291 }
10292
10293 hard_frame_pointer_adjustment = -1;
10294 VTI (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR_FOR_FN (cfun))->flooded = true;
10295 cfa_base_rtx = NULL_RTX;
10296 return true;
10297 }
10298
10299 /* This is *not* reset after each function. It gives each
10300 NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL in the entire compilation
10301 a unique label number. */
10302
10303 static int debug_label_num = 1;
10304
10305 /* Remove from the insn stream a single debug insn used for
10306 variable tracking at assignments. */
10307
10308 static inline void
10309 delete_vta_debug_insn (rtx_insn *insn)
10310 {
10311 if (DEBUG_MARKER_INSN_P (insn))
10312 {
10313 reemit_marker_as_note (insn);
10314 return;
10315 }
10316
10317 tree decl = INSN_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (insn);
10318 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == LABEL_DECL
10319 && DECL_NAME (decl)
10320 && !DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl))
10321 {
10322 PUT_CODE (insn, NOTE);
10323 NOTE_KIND (insn) = NOTE_INSN_DELETED_DEBUG_LABEL;
10324 NOTE_DELETED_LABEL_NAME (insn)
10325 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (decl));
10326 SET_DECL_RTL (decl, insn);
10327 CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn) = debug_label_num++;
10328 }
10329 else
10330 delete_insn (insn);
10331 }
10332
10333 /* Remove from the insn stream all debug insns used for variable
10334 tracking at assignments. USE_CFG should be false if the cfg is no
10335 longer usable. */
10336
10337 void
10338 delete_vta_debug_insns (bool use_cfg)
10339 {
10340 basic_block bb;
10341 rtx_insn *insn, *next;
10342
10343 if (!MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
10344 return;
10345
10346 if (use_cfg)
10347 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
10348 {
10349 FOR_BB_INSNS_SAFE (bb, insn, next)
10350 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
10351 delete_vta_debug_insn (insn);
10352 }
10353 else
10354 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = next)
10355 {
10356 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
10357 if (DEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
10358 delete_vta_debug_insn (insn);
10359 }
10360 }
10361
10362 /* Run a fast, BB-local only version of var tracking, to take care of
10363 information that we don't do global analysis on, such that not all
10364 information is lost. If SKIPPED holds, we're skipping the global
10365 pass entirely, so we should try to use information it would have
10366 handled as well.. */
10367
10368 static void
10369 vt_debug_insns_local (bool skipped ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10370 {
10371 /* ??? Just skip it all for now. */
10372 delete_vta_debug_insns (true);
10373 }
10374
10375 /* Free the data structures needed for variable tracking. */
10376
10377 static void
10378 vt_finalize (void)
10379 {
10380 basic_block bb;
10381
10382 FOR_EACH_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
10383 {
10384 VTI (bb)->mos.release ();
10385 }
10386
10387 FOR_ALL_BB_FN (bb, cfun)
10388 {
10389 dataflow_set_destroy (&VTI (bb)->in);
10390 dataflow_set_destroy (&VTI (bb)->out);
10391 if (VTI (bb)->permp)
10392 {
10393 dataflow_set_destroy (VTI (bb)->permp);
10394 XDELETE (VTI (bb)->permp);
10395 }
10396 }
10397 free_aux_for_blocks ();
10398 delete empty_shared_hash->htab;
10399 empty_shared_hash->htab = NULL;
10400 delete changed_variables;
10401 changed_variables = NULL;
10402 attrs_pool.release ();
10403 var_pool.release ();
10404 location_chain_pool.release ();
10405 shared_hash_pool.release ();
10406
10407 if (MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_BIND_INSNS)
10408 {
10409 if (global_get_addr_cache)
10410 delete global_get_addr_cache;
10411 global_get_addr_cache = NULL;
10412 loc_exp_dep_pool.release ();
10413 valvar_pool.release ();
10414 preserved_values.release ();
10415 cselib_finish ();
10416 BITMAP_FREE (scratch_regs);
10417 scratch_regs = NULL;
10418 }
10419
10420 #ifdef HAVE_window_save
10421 vec_free (windowed_parm_regs);
10422 #endif
10423
10424 if (vui_vec)
10425 XDELETEVEC (vui_vec);
10426 vui_vec = NULL;
10427 vui_allocated = 0;
10428 }
10429
10430 /* The entry point to variable tracking pass. */
10431
10432 static inline unsigned int
10433 variable_tracking_main_1 (void)
10434 {
10435 bool success;
10436
10437 /* We won't be called as a separate pass if flag_var_tracking is not
10438 set, but final may call us to turn debug markers into notes. */
10439 if ((!flag_var_tracking && MAY_HAVE_DEBUG_INSNS)
10440 || flag_var_tracking_assignments < 0
10441 /* Var-tracking right now assumes the IR doesn't contain
10442 any pseudos at this point. */
10443 || targetm.no_register_allocation)
10444 {
10445 delete_vta_debug_insns (true);
10446 return 0;
10447 }
10448
10449 if (!flag_var_tracking)
10450 return 0;
10451
10452 if (n_basic_blocks_for_fn (cfun) > 500
10453 && n_edges_for_fn (cfun) / n_basic_blocks_for_fn (cfun) >= 20)
10454 {
10455 vt_debug_insns_local (true);
10456 return 0;
10457 }
10458
10459 mark_dfs_back_edges ();
10460 if (!vt_initialize ())
10461 {
10462 vt_finalize ();
10463 vt_debug_insns_local (true);
10464 return 0;
10465 }
10466
10467 success = vt_find_locations ();
10468
10469 if (!success && flag_var_tracking_assignments > 0)
10470 {
10471 vt_finalize ();
10472
10473 delete_vta_debug_insns (true);
10474
10475 /* This is later restored by our caller. */
10476 flag_var_tracking_assignments = 0;
10477
10478 success = vt_initialize ();
10479 gcc_assert (success);
10480
10481 success = vt_find_locations ();
10482 }
10483
10484 if (!success)
10485 {
10486 vt_finalize ();
10487 vt_debug_insns_local (false);
10488 return 0;
10489 }
10490
10491 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
10492 {
10493 dump_dataflow_sets ();
10494 dump_reg_info (dump_file);
10495 dump_flow_info (dump_file, dump_flags);
10496 }
10497
10498 timevar_push (TV_VAR_TRACKING_EMIT);
10499 vt_emit_notes ();
10500 timevar_pop (TV_VAR_TRACKING_EMIT);
10501
10502 vt_finalize ();
10503 vt_debug_insns_local (false);
10504 return 0;
10505 }
10506
10507 unsigned int
10508 variable_tracking_main (void)
10509 {
10510 unsigned int ret;
10511 int save = flag_var_tracking_assignments;
10512
10513 ret = variable_tracking_main_1 ();
10514
10515 flag_var_tracking_assignments = save;
10516
10517 return ret;
10518 }
10519 \f
10520 namespace {
10521
10522 const pass_data pass_data_variable_tracking =
10523 {
10524 RTL_PASS, /* type */
10525 "vartrack", /* name */
10526 OPTGROUP_NONE, /* optinfo_flags */
10527 TV_VAR_TRACKING, /* tv_id */
10528 0, /* properties_required */
10529 0, /* properties_provided */
10530 0, /* properties_destroyed */
10531 0, /* todo_flags_start */
10532 0, /* todo_flags_finish */
10533 };
10534
10535 class pass_variable_tracking : public rtl_opt_pass
10536 {
10537 public:
10538 pass_variable_tracking (gcc::context *ctxt)
10539 : rtl_opt_pass (pass_data_variable_tracking, ctxt)
10540 {}
10541
10542 /* opt_pass methods: */
10543 virtual bool gate (function *)
10544 {
10545 return (flag_var_tracking && !targetm.delay_vartrack);
10546 }
10547
10548 virtual unsigned int execute (function *)
10549 {
10550 return variable_tracking_main ();
10551 }
10552
10553 }; // class pass_variable_tracking
10554
10555 } // anon namespace
10556
10557 rtl_opt_pass *
10558 make_pass_variable_tracking (gcc::context *ctxt)
10559 {
10560 return new pass_variable_tracking (ctxt);
10561 }